]> gcc.gnu.org Git - gcc.git/blob - gcc/doc/tm.texi
tm.texi (MD_CAN_REDIRECT_BRANCH): New macro.
[gcc.git] / gcc / doc / tm.texi
1 @c Copyright (C) 1988,1989,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1997,1998,1999,2000,2001
2 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c This is part of the GCC manual.
4 @c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
5
6 @node Target Macros
7 @chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
8 @cindex machine description macros
9 @cindex target description macros
10 @cindex macros, target description
11 @cindex @file{tm.h} macros
12
13 In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
14 includes a C header file conventionally given the name
15 @file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
16 The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
17 about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
18 @file{.md} file. The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
19 @file{@var{machine}.h}. The header file @file{config.h} includes
20 @file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}. The
21 source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
22 containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
23 machine. @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
24 if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
25 through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
26
27 @menu
28 * Target Structure:: The @code{targetm} variable.
29 * Driver:: Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
30 * Run-time Target:: Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
31 * Per-Function Data:: Defining data structures for per-function information.
32 * Storage Layout:: Defining sizes and alignments of data.
33 * Type Layout:: Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
34 * Escape Sequences:: Defining the value of target character escape sequences
35 * Registers:: Naming and describing the hardware registers.
36 * Register Classes:: Defining the classes of hardware registers.
37 * Stack and Calling:: Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
38 * Varargs:: Defining the varargs macros.
39 * Trampolines:: Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
40 * Library Calls:: Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
41 * Addressing Modes:: Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
42 * Condition Code:: Defining how insns update the condition code.
43 * Costs:: Defining relative costs of different operations.
44 * Sections:: Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
45 * PIC:: Macros for position independent code.
46 * Assembler Format:: Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
47 * Debugging Info:: Defining the format of debugging output.
48 * Cross-compilation:: Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
49 * Mode Switching:: Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
50 * Misc:: Everything else.
51 @end menu
52
53 @node Target Structure
54 @section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
55 @cindex target hooks
56 @cindex target functions
57
58 @deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
59 The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
60 which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
61 machine. The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
62 @file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
63 used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
64 for elements of the structure. The @file{.c} file should override those
65 macros for which the default definition is inappropriate. For example:
66 @smallexample
67 #include "target.h"
68 #include "target-def.h"
69
70 /* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.} */
71
72 #undef TARGET_VALID_TYPE_ATTRIBUTE
73 #define TARGET_VALID_TYPE_ATTRIBUTE @var{machine}_valid_type_attribute_p
74
75 struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
76 @end smallexample
77 @end deftypevar
78
79 Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
80 form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
81 ``Target Hook'' with a prototype. Many macros will change in future
82 from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
83 @code{targetm} structure.
84
85 @node Driver
86 @section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
87 @cindex driver
88 @cindex controlling the compilation driver
89
90 @c prevent bad page break with this line
91 You can control the compilation driver.
92
93 @table @code
94 @findex SWITCH_TAKES_ARG
95 @item SWITCH_TAKES_ARG (@var{char})
96 A C expression which determines whether the option @option{-@var{char}}
97 takes arguments. The value should be the number of arguments that
98 option takes--zero, for many options.
99
100 By default, this macro is defined as
101 @code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG}, which handles the standard options
102 properly. You need not define @code{SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} unless you
103 wish to add additional options which take arguments. Any redefinition
104 should call @code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} and then check for
105 additional options.
106
107 @findex WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG
108 @item WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG (@var{name})
109 A C expression which determines whether the option @option{-@var{name}}
110 takes arguments. The value should be the number of arguments that
111 option takes--zero, for many options. This macro rather than
112 @code{SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} is used for multi-character option names.
113
114 By default, this macro is defined as
115 @code{DEFAULT_WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG}, which handles the standard options
116 properly. You need not define @code{WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} unless you
117 wish to add additional options which take arguments. Any redefinition
118 should call @code{DEFAULT_WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} and then check for
119 additional options.
120
121 @findex SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION
122 @item SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION (@var{char})
123 A C expression which determines whether the option @option{-@var{char}}
124 stops compilation before the generation of an executable. The value is
125 boolean, non-zero if the option does stop an executable from being
126 generated, zero otherwise.
127
128 By default, this macro is defined as
129 @code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION}, which handles the standard
130 options properly. You need not define
131 @code{SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION} unless you wish to add additional
132 options which affect the generation of an executable. Any redefinition
133 should call @code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION} and then check
134 for additional options.
135
136 @findex SWITCHES_NEED_SPACES
137 @item SWITCHES_NEED_SPACES
138 A string-valued C expression which enumerates the options for which
139 the linker needs a space between the option and its argument.
140
141 If this macro is not defined, the default value is @code{""}.
142
143 @findex TARGET_OPTION_TRANSLATE_TABLE
144 @item TARGET_OPTION_TRANSLATE_TABLE
145 If defined, a list of pairs of strings, the first of which is a
146 potential command line target to the @file{gcc} driver program, and the
147 second of which is a space-separated (tabs and other whitespace are not
148 supported) list of options with which to replace the first option. The
149 target defining this list is responsible for assuring that the results
150 are valid. Replacement options may not be the @code{--opt} style, they
151 must be the @code{-opt} style. It is the intention of this macro to
152 provide a mechanism for substitution that affects the multilibs chosen,
153 such as one option that enables many options, some of which select
154 multilibs. Example nonsensical definition, where @code{-malt-abi},
155 @code{-EB}, and @code{-mspoo} cause different multilibs to be chosen:
156
157 @example
158 #define TARGET_OPTION_TRANSLATE_TABLE \
159 @{ "-fast", "-march=fast-foo -malt-abi -I/usr/fast-foo" @}, \
160 @{ "-compat", "-EB -malign=4 -mspoo" @}
161 @end example
162
163 @findex CPP_SPEC
164 @item CPP_SPEC
165 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
166 pass to CPP@. It can also specify how to translate options you
167 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
168
169 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
170
171 @findex CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
172 @item CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
173 This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
174 than C@. If you do not define this macro, then the value of
175 @code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
176
177 @findex NO_BUILTIN_SIZE_TYPE
178 @item NO_BUILTIN_SIZE_TYPE
179 If this macro is defined, the preprocessor will not define the built-in macro
180 @code{__SIZE_TYPE__}. The macro @code{__SIZE_TYPE__} must then be defined
181 by @code{CPP_SPEC} instead.
182
183 This should be defined if @code{SIZE_TYPE} depends on target dependent flags
184 which are not accessible to the preprocessor. Otherwise, it should not
185 be defined.
186
187 @findex NO_BUILTIN_PTRDIFF_TYPE
188 @item NO_BUILTIN_PTRDIFF_TYPE
189 If this macro is defined, the preprocessor will not define the built-in macro
190 @code{__PTRDIFF_TYPE__}. The macro @code{__PTRDIFF_TYPE__} must then be
191 defined by @code{CPP_SPEC} instead.
192
193 This should be defined if @code{PTRDIFF_TYPE} depends on target dependent flags
194 which are not accessible to the preprocessor. Otherwise, it should not
195 be defined.
196
197 @findex NO_BUILTIN_WCHAR_TYPE
198 @item NO_BUILTIN_WCHAR_TYPE
199 If this macro is defined, the preprocessor will not define the built-in macro
200 @code{__WCHAR_TYPE__}. The macro @code{__WCHAR_TYPE__} must then be
201 defined by @code{CPP_SPEC} instead.
202
203 This should be defined if @code{WCHAR_TYPE} depends on target dependent flags
204 which are not accessible to the preprocessor. Otherwise, it should not
205 be defined.
206
207 @findex NO_BUILTIN_WINT_TYPE
208 @item NO_BUILTIN_WINT_TYPE
209 If this macro is defined, the preprocessor will not define the built-in macro
210 @code{__WINT_TYPE__}. The macro @code{__WINT_TYPE__} must then be
211 defined by @code{CPP_SPEC} instead.
212
213 This should be defined if @code{WINT_TYPE} depends on target dependent flags
214 which are not accessible to the preprocessor. Otherwise, it should not
215 be defined.
216
217 @findex SIGNED_CHAR_SPEC
218 @item SIGNED_CHAR_SPEC
219 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
220 pass to CPP@. By default, this macro is defined to pass the option
221 @option{-D__CHAR_UNSIGNED__} to CPP if @code{char} will be treated as
222 @code{unsigned char} by @code{cc1}.
223
224 Do not define this macro unless you need to override the default
225 definition.
226
227 @findex CC1_SPEC
228 @item CC1_SPEC
229 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
230 pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
231 front ends.
232 It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
233 for GCC to pass to front ends.
234
235 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
236
237 @findex CC1PLUS_SPEC
238 @item CC1PLUS_SPEC
239 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
240 pass to @code{cc1plus}. It can also specify how to translate options you
241 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
242
243 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
244 Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
245 @code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
246 CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
247
248 @findex ASM_SPEC
249 @item ASM_SPEC
250 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
251 pass to the assembler. It can also specify how to translate options
252 you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
253 See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
254
255 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
256
257 @findex ASM_FINAL_SPEC
258 @item ASM_FINAL_SPEC
259 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
260 run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
261 Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{mips.h} for
262 an example of this.
263
264 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
265
266 @findex LINK_SPEC
267 @item LINK_SPEC
268 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
269 pass to the linker. It can also specify how to translate options you
270 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
271
272 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
273
274 @findex LIB_SPEC
275 @item LIB_SPEC
276 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The difference
277 between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
278 command given to the linker.
279
280 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
281 loads the standard C library from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
282
283 @findex LIBGCC_SPEC
284 @item LIBGCC_SPEC
285 Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
286 how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
287 linker command line. This constant is placed both before and after
288 the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
289
290 If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
291 passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
292
293 @findex STARTFILE_SPEC
294 @item STARTFILE_SPEC
295 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
296 difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
297 the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
298
299 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
300 standard C startup file from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
301
302 @findex ENDFILE_SPEC
303 @item ENDFILE_SPEC
304 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
305 difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
306 the very end of the command given to the linker.
307
308 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
309
310 @findex THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
311 @item THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
312 GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
313 However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
314 models, such as AIX 4.3. On such platforms, define
315 @code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
316 blanks that names one of the recognized thread models. @code{%*}, the
317 default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
318 @code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
319
320 @findex EXTRA_SPECS
321 @item EXTRA_SPECS
322 Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
323 @file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
324 @code{CC1_SPEC}.
325
326 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
327 containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
328 string constant that provides the specification.
329
330 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
331
332 @code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
333 related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
334 to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
335 these definitions.
336
337 For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
338 define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
339 used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
340 used.
341
342 The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
343
344 @example
345 #define EXTRA_SPECS \
346 @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
347
348 #define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
349 @end example
350
351 The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
352 @smallexample
353 #undef CPP_SPEC
354 #define CPP_SPEC \
355 "%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
356 %@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} %@{mcall-aix: -D_CALL_AIX @} \
357 %@{!mcall-sysv: %@{!mcall-aix: %(cpp_sysv_default) @}@} \
358 %@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
359
360 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
361 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
362 @end smallexample
363
364 while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
365 @code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
366
367 @smallexample
368 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
369 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
370 @end smallexample
371
372 @findex LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL
373 @item LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL
374 Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
375 @file{libgcc.a} itself and should not pass @option{-L} options to the
376 linker. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
377 the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search and will
378 pass @option{-L} options to it.
379
380 @findex LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
381 @item LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
382 Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
383 @file{libgcc.a}. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
384 the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
385 This macro is similar to @code{LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL}, except that it does
386 not affect @option{-L} options.
387
388 @findex LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
389 @item LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
390 A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
391 linker. When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
392 change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}. Therefore,
393 define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
394 line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
395 the effect you need.
396
397 @findex LINK_ELIMINATE_DUPLICATE_LDIRECTORIES
398 @item LINK_ELIMINATE_DUPLICATE_LDIRECTORIES
399 A nonzero value causes collect2 to remove duplicate @option{-L@var{directory}} search
400 directories from linking commands. Do not give it a nonzero value if
401 removing duplicate search directories changes the linker's semantics.
402
403 @findex MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
404 @item MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
405 Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
406 string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
407 target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
408 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
409
410 Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
411 the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
412 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
413 @xref{Target Fragment}.
414
415 @findex RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
416 @item RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
417 Define this macro to tell @code{gcc} that it should only translate
418 a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
419 indicates an absolute file name.
420
421 @findex STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX
422 @item STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX
423 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
424 standard choice of @file{/usr/local/lib/gcc-lib/} as the default prefix to
425 try when searching for the executable files of the compiler.
426
427 @findex MD_EXEC_PREFIX
428 @item MD_EXEC_PREFIX
429 If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
430 @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
431 when the @option{-b} option is used, or the compiler is built as a cross
432 compiler. If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
433 to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.in}.
434
435 @findex STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
436 @item STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
437 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
438 standard choice of @file{/usr/local/lib/} as the default prefix to
439 try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
440
441 @findex MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
442 @item MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
443 If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
444 standard prefixes. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
445 @option{-b} option is used, or when the compiler is built as a cross
446 compiler.
447
448 @findex MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
449 @item MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
450 If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
451 standard prefixes. It is not searched when the @option{-b} option is
452 used, or when the compiler is built as a cross compiler.
453
454 @findex INIT_ENVIRONMENT
455 @item INIT_ENVIRONMENT
456 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
457 variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
458 loader. The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
459 initialize the necessary environment variables.
460
461 @findex LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
462 @item LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
463 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
464 standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
465 try when searching for local header files. @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
466 comes before @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
467
468 Cross compilers do not use this macro and do not search either
469 @file{/usr/local/include} or its replacement.
470
471 @findex MODIFY_TARGET_NAME
472 @item MODIFY_TARGET_NAME
473 Define this macro if you with to define command-line switches that modify the
474 default target name
475
476 For each switch, you can include a string to be appended to the first
477 part of the configuration name or a string to be deleted from the
478 configuration name, if present. The definition should be an initializer
479 for an array of structures. Each array element should have three
480 elements: the switch name (a string constant, including the initial
481 dash), one of the enumeration codes @code{ADD} or @code{DELETE} to
482 indicate whether the string should be inserted or deleted, and the string
483 to be inserted or deleted (a string constant).
484
485 For example, on a machine where @samp{64} at the end of the
486 configuration name denotes a 64-bit target and you want the @option{-32}
487 and @option{-64} switches to select between 32- and 64-bit targets, you would
488 code
489
490 @smallexample
491 #define MODIFY_TARGET_NAME \
492 @{ @{ "-32", DELETE, "64"@}, \
493 @{"-64", ADD, "64"@}@}
494 @end smallexample
495
496
497 @findex SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR
498 @item SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR
499 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to specify a
500 system-specific directory to search for header files before the standard
501 directory. @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} comes before
502 @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
503
504 Cross compilers do not use this macro and do not search the directory
505 specified.
506
507 @findex STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR
508 @item STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR
509 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
510 standard choice of @file{/usr/include} as the default prefix to
511 try when searching for header files.
512
513 Cross compilers do not use this macro and do not search either
514 @file{/usr/include} or its replacement.
515
516 @findex STANDARD_INCLUDE_COMPONENT
517 @item STANDARD_INCLUDE_COMPONENT
518 The ``component'' corresponding to @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}.
519 See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
520 If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
521
522 @findex INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
523 @item INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
524 Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
525 for include files. For a native compiler, the default search path
526 usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
527 @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
528 @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}. In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
529 and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
530 and specify private search areas for GCC@. The directory
531 @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
532
533 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
534 Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
535 string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
536 for C++-only directories,
537 and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
538 wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++. Mark the end of
539 the array with a null element.
540
541 The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
542 if any, in all upper-case letters. For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
543 or @samp{BINUTILS}. If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
544 operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
545
546 For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
547
548 @example
549 #define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
550 @{ \
551 @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@}, \
552 @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@}, \
553 @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@}, \
554 @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@}, \
555 @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@} \
556 @}
557 @end example
558 @end table
559
560 Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
561
562 @enumerate
563 @item
564 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
565
566 @item
567 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}, if any.
568
569 @item
570 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
571
572 @item
573 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}.
574
575 @item
576 @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}.
577
578 @item
579 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if any.
580 @end enumerate
581
582 Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
583
584 @enumerate
585 @item
586 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
587
588 @item
589 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}, if any.
590
591 @item
592 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
593 (or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
594
595 @item
596 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}.
597
598 @item
599 @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}.
600
601 @item
602 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if any.
603
604 @item
605 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if any.
606
607 @item
608 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}.
609
610 @item
611 @file{/lib/}.
612
613 @item
614 @file{/usr/lib/}.
615 @end enumerate
616
617 @node Run-time Target
618 @section Run-time Target Specification
619 @cindex run-time target specification
620 @cindex predefined macros
621 @cindex target specifications
622
623 @c prevent bad page break with this line
624 Here are run-time target specifications.
625
626 @table @code
627 @findex CPP_PREDEFINES
628 @item CPP_PREDEFINES
629 Define this to be a string constant containing @option{-D} options to
630 define the predefined macros that identify this machine and system.
631 These macros will be predefined unless the @option{-ansi} option (or a
632 @option{-std} option for strict ISO C conformance) is specified.
633
634 In addition, a parallel set of macros are predefined, whose names are
635 made by appending @samp{__} at the beginning and at the end. These
636 @samp{__} macros are permitted by the ISO standard, so they are
637 predefined regardless of whether @option{-ansi} or a @option{-std} option
638 is specified.
639
640 For example, on the Sun, one can use the following value:
641
642 @smallexample
643 "-Dmc68000 -Dsun -Dunix"
644 @end smallexample
645
646 The result is to define the macros @code{__mc68000__}, @code{__sun__}
647 and @code{__unix__} unconditionally, and the macros @code{mc68000},
648 @code{sun} and @code{unix} provided @option{-ansi} is not specified.
649
650 @findex extern int target_flags
651 @item extern int target_flags;
652 This declaration should be present.
653
654 @cindex optional hardware or system features
655 @cindex features, optional, in system conventions
656 @item TARGET_@dots{}
657 This series of macros is to allow compiler command arguments to
658 enable or disable the use of optional features of the target machine.
659 For example, one machine description serves both the 68000 and
660 the 68020; a command argument tells the compiler whether it should
661 use 68020-only instructions or not. This command argument works
662 by means of a macro @code{TARGET_68020} that tests a bit in
663 @code{target_flags}.
664
665 Define a macro @code{TARGET_@var{featurename}} for each such option.
666 Its definition should test a bit in @code{target_flags}. It is
667 recommended that a helper macro @code{TARGET_MASK_@var{featurename}}
668 is defined for each bit-value to test, and used in
669 @code{TARGET_@var{featurename}} and @code{TARGET_SWITCHES}. For
670 example:
671
672 @smallexample
673 #define TARGET_MASK_68020 1
674 #define TARGET_68020 (target_flags & TARGET_MASK_68020)
675 @end smallexample
676
677 One place where these macros are used is in the condition-expressions
678 of instruction patterns. Note how @code{TARGET_68020} appears
679 frequently in the 68000 machine description file, @file{m68k.md}.
680 Another place they are used is in the definitions of the other
681 macros in the @file{@var{machine}.h} file.
682
683 @findex TARGET_SWITCHES
684 @item TARGET_SWITCHES
685 This macro defines names of command options to set and clear
686 bits in @code{target_flags}. Its definition is an initializer
687 with a subgrouping for each command option.
688
689 Each subgrouping contains a string constant, that defines the option
690 name, a number, which contains the bits to set in
691 @code{target_flags}, and a second string which is the description
692 displayed by @option{--help}. If the number is negative then the bits specified
693 by the number are cleared instead of being set. If the description
694 string is present but empty, then no help information will be displayed
695 for that option, but it will not count as an undocumented option. The
696 actual option name is made by appending @samp{-m} to the specified name.
697 Non-empty description strings should be marked with @code{N_(@dots{})} for
698 @command{xgettext}. In addition to the description for @option{--help},
699 more detailed documentation for each option should be added to
700 @file{invoke.texi}.
701
702 One of the subgroupings should have a null string. The number in
703 this grouping is the default value for @code{target_flags}. Any
704 target options act starting with that value.
705
706 Here is an example which defines @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}
707 with opposite meanings, and picks the latter as the default:
708
709 @smallexample
710 #define TARGET_SWITCHES \
711 @{ @{ "68020", TARGET_MASK_68020, "" @}, \
712 @{ "68000", -TARGET_MASK_68020, \
713 N_("Compile for the 68000") @}, \
714 @{ "", TARGET_MASK_68020, "" @}@}
715 @end smallexample
716
717 @findex TARGET_OPTIONS
718 @item TARGET_OPTIONS
719 This macro is similar to @code{TARGET_SWITCHES} but defines names of command
720 options that have values. Its definition is an initializer with a
721 subgrouping for each command option.
722
723 Each subgrouping contains a string constant, that defines the fixed part
724 of the option name, the address of a variable, and a description string
725 (which should again be marked with @code{N_(@dots{})}).
726 The variable, type @code{char *}, is set to the variable part of the
727 given option if the fixed part matches. The actual option name is made
728 by appending @samp{-m} to the specified name. Again, each option should
729 also be documented in @file{invoke.texi}.
730
731 Here is an example which defines @option{-mshort-data-@var{number}}. If the
732 given option is @option{-mshort-data-512}, the variable @code{m88k_short_data}
733 will be set to the string @code{"512"}.
734
735 @smallexample
736 extern char *m88k_short_data;
737 #define TARGET_OPTIONS \
738 @{ @{ "short-data-", &m88k_short_data, \
739 N_("Specify the size of the short data section") @} @}
740 @end smallexample
741
742 @findex TARGET_VERSION
743 @item TARGET_VERSION
744 This macro is a C statement to print on @code{stderr} a string
745 describing the particular machine description choice. Every machine
746 description should define @code{TARGET_VERSION}. For example:
747
748 @smallexample
749 #ifdef MOTOROLA
750 #define TARGET_VERSION \
751 fprintf (stderr, " (68k, Motorola syntax)");
752 #else
753 #define TARGET_VERSION \
754 fprintf (stderr, " (68k, MIT syntax)");
755 #endif
756 @end smallexample
757
758 @findex OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
759 @item OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
760 Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
761 a particular target machine. You can define a macro
762 @code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS} to take account of this. This macro, if
763 defined, is executed once just after all the command options have been
764 parsed.
765
766 Don't use this macro to turn on various extra optimizations for
767 @option{-O}. That is what @code{OPTIMIZATION_OPTIONS} is for.
768
769 @findex OPTIMIZATION_OPTIONS
770 @item OPTIMIZATION_OPTIONS (@var{level}, @var{size})
771 Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
772 various optimization levels. This macro, if defined, is executed once
773 just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
774 of the command options have been parsed. Values set in this macro are
775 used as the default values for the other command line options.
776
777 @var{level} is the optimization level specified; 2 if @option{-O2} is
778 specified, 1 if @option{-O} is specified, and 0 if neither is specified.
779
780 @var{size} is non-zero if @option{-Os} is specified and zero otherwise.
781
782 You should not use this macro to change options that are not
783 machine-specific. These should uniformly selected by the same
784 optimization level on all supported machines. Use this macro to enable
785 machine-specific optimizations.
786
787 @strong{Do not examine @code{write_symbols} in
788 this macro!} The debugging options are not supposed to alter the
789 generated code.
790
791 @findex CAN_DEBUG_WITHOUT_FP
792 @item CAN_DEBUG_WITHOUT_FP
793 Define this macro if debugging can be performed even without a frame
794 pointer. If this macro is defined, GCC will turn on the
795 @option{-fomit-frame-pointer} option whenever @option{-O} is specified.
796 @end table
797
798 @node Per-Function Data
799 @section Defining data structures for per-function information.
800 @cindex per-function data
801 @cindex data structures
802
803 If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
804 provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this. Note, just
805 using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
806 nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
807 when another one comes along.
808
809 GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
810 contains all of the data specific to an individual function. This
811 structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
812 @code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
813 to their own specific data.
814
815 If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
816 @code{struct machine_function} and also the macro
817 @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}. This macro should be used to initialise some or
818 all of the function pointers @code{init_machine_status},
819 @code{free_machine_status} and @code{mark_machine_status}. These
820 pointers are explained below.
821
822 One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
823 RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address. This
824 RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
825 function, for level 0.
826
827 Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
828 all of the per-function information. Thus when processing of a nested
829 function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
830 stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
831 stack. GCC used to provide function pointers called
832 @code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
833 the saving and restoring of the target specific information. Since the
834 single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
835 longer supported.
836
837 The macro and function pointers are described below.
838
839 @table @code
840 @findex INIT_EXPANDERS
841 @item INIT_EXPANDERS
842 Macro called to initialise any target specific information. This macro
843 is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
844 The intention of this macro is to allow the initialisation of the
845 function pointers below.
846
847 @findex init_machine_status
848 @item init_machine_status
849 This is a @code{void (*)(struct function *)} function pointer. If this
850 pointer is non-NULL it will be called once per function, before function
851 compilation starts, in order to allow the target to perform any target
852 specific initialisation of the @code{struct function} structure. It is
853 intended that this would be used to initialise the @code{machine} of
854 that structure.
855
856 @findex free_machine_status
857 @item free_machine_status
858 This is a @code{void (*)(struct function *)} function pointer. If this
859 pointer is non-NULL it will be called once per function, after the
860 function has been compiled, in order to allow any memory allocated
861 during the @code{init_machine_status} function call to be freed.
862
863 @findex mark_machine_status
864 @item mark_machine_status
865 This is a @code{void (*)(struct function *)} function pointer. If this
866 pointer is non-NULL it will be called once per function in order to mark
867 any data items in the @code{struct machine_function} structure which
868 need garbage collection.
869
870 @end table
871
872 @node Storage Layout
873 @section Storage Layout
874 @cindex storage layout
875
876 Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
877 alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant. They can be C
878 expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
879 @xref{Run-time Target}.
880
881 @table @code
882 @findex BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
883 @item BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
884 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
885 byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
886 This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
887 bit. If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
888 be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to. This
889 macro need not be a constant.
890
891 This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
892 bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
893
894 @findex BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
895 @item BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
896 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
897 word has the lowest number. This macro need not be a constant.
898
899 @findex WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
900 @item WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
901 Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
902 most significant word has the lowest number. This applies to both
903 memory locations and registers; GCC fundamentally assumes that the
904 order of words in memory is the same as the order in registers. This
905 macro need not be a constant.
906
907 @findex LIBGCC2_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
908 @item LIBGCC2_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
909 Define this macro if @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} is not constant. This must be a
910 constant value with the same meaning as @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN}, which will be
911 used only when compiling @file{libgcc2.c}. Typically the value will be set
912 based on preprocessor defines.
913
914 @findex FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
915 @item FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
916 Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
917 @code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
918 containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
919 have the value 0. This macro need not be a constant.
920
921 You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
922 multi-word integers.
923
924 @findex BITS_PER_UNIT
925 @item BITS_PER_UNIT
926 Define this macro to be the number of bits in an addressable storage
927 unit (byte); normally 8.
928
929 @findex BITS_PER_WORD
930 @item BITS_PER_WORD
931 Number of bits in a word; normally 32.
932
933 @findex MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
934 @item MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
935 Maximum number of bits in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
936 @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
937 largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
938
939 @findex UNITS_PER_WORD
940 @item UNITS_PER_WORD
941 Number of storage units in a word; normally 4.
942
943 @findex MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
944 @item MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
945 Minimum number of units in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
946 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
947 smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
948
949 @findex POINTER_SIZE
950 @item POINTER_SIZE
951 Width of a pointer, in bits. You must specify a value no wider than the
952 width of @code{Pmode}. If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
953 you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}.
954
955 @findex POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
956 @item POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
957 A C expression whose value is greater than zero if pointers that need to be
958 extended from being @code{POINTER_SIZE} bits wide to @code{Pmode} are to
959 be zero-extended and zero if they are to be sign-extended. If the value
960 is less then zero then there must be an "ptr_extend" instruction that
961 extends a pointer from @code{POINTER_SIZE} to @code{Pmode}.
962
963 You need not define this macro if the @code{POINTER_SIZE} is equal
964 to the width of @code{Pmode}.
965
966 @findex PROMOTE_MODE
967 @item PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
968 A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
969 is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
970 stored in a register. This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
971 scalar type.
972
973 On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
974 register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
975 @var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. In most
976 cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
977 floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
978 counterparts.
979
980 For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
981 However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
982 either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes. For example, on
983 the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
984 sign-extend the result to 64 bits. On such machines, set
985 @var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
986
987 Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
988
989 @findex PROMOTE_FUNCTION_ARGS
990 @item PROMOTE_FUNCTION_ARGS
991 Define this macro if the promotion described by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}
992 should also be done for outgoing function arguments.
993
994 @findex PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN
995 @item PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN
996 Define this macro if the promotion described by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}
997 should also be done for the return value of functions.
998
999 If this macro is defined, @code{FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same
1000 promotions done by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
1001
1002 @findex PROMOTE_FOR_CALL_ONLY
1003 @item PROMOTE_FOR_CALL_ONLY
1004 Define this macro if the promotion described by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}
1005 should @emph{only} be performed for outgoing function arguments or
1006 function return values, as specified by @code{PROMOTE_FUNCTION_ARGS}
1007 and @code{PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN}, respectively.
1008
1009 @findex PARM_BOUNDARY
1010 @item PARM_BOUNDARY
1011 Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
1012 bits. All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
1013 regardless of data type. On most machines, this is the same as the
1014 size of an integer.
1015
1016 @findex STACK_BOUNDARY
1017 @item STACK_BOUNDARY
1018 Define this macro if there is a guaranteed alignment for the stack
1019 pointer on this machine. The definition is a C expression
1020 for the desired alignment (measured in bits). This value is used as a
1021 default if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined.
1022
1023 @findex PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
1024 @item PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
1025 Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for
1026 the stack pointer. The definition is a C expression
1027 for the desired alignment (measured in bits). If @code{STACK_BOUNDARY} is
1028 also defined, this macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger
1029 than @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1030
1031 @cindex @code{PUSH_ROUNDING}, interaction with @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}
1032 If @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} is not defined, the stack will always be aligned
1033 to the specified boundary. If @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} is defined and specifies
1034 a less strict alignment than @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, the stack may
1035 be momentarily unaligned while pushing arguments.
1036
1037 @findex FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
1038 @item FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
1039 Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
1040
1041 @findex BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1042 @item BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1043 Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in bits.
1044
1045 @findex MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1046 @item MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1047 If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1048 object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1049 nearby object. Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1050 on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
1051
1052 @findex BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1053 @item BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1054 Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1055 machine, in bits. If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1056 structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1057 by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1058
1059 @findex ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN
1060 @item ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{computed})
1061 An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} if the
1062 alignment computed in the usual way is @var{computed}. GCC uses
1063 this value instead of the value in @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} or
1064 @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT}, if defined, for structure fields only.
1065
1066 @findex MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1067 @item MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1068 Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1069 Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1070 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. If not defined,
1071 the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1072
1073 @findex DATA_ALIGNMENT
1074 @item DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1075 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1076 the static store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1077 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1078 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1079
1080 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1081
1082 @findex strcpy
1083 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1084 make it all fit in fewer cache lines. Another is to cause character
1085 arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1086 constants to character arrays can be done inline.
1087
1088 @findex CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT
1089 @item CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
1090 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
1091 that is being placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and
1092 @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
1093 have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1094 align the object.
1095
1096 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1097
1098 The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
1099 constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1100 constants can be done inline.
1101
1102 @findex LOCAL_ALIGNMENT
1103 @item LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1104 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1105 the local store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1106 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1107 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1108
1109 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1110
1111 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1112 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1113
1114 @findex EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1115 @item EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1116 Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
1117 empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1118
1119 Note that @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} also affects the alignment
1120 that results from an empty field.
1121
1122 @findex STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1123 @item STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1124 Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1125 Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1126
1127 If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1128 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1129
1130 @findex STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1131 @item STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1132 Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1133 if given data not on the nominal alignment. If instructions will merely
1134 go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
1135
1136 @findex PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1137 @item PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1138 Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
1139 alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
1140
1141 The behavior is that the type written for a bit-field (@code{int},
1142 @code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the
1143 entire structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary
1144 field of that type. In addition, the bit-field is placed within the
1145 structure so that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a
1146 boundary for it.
1147
1148 Thus, on most machines, a bit-field whose type is written as @code{int}
1149 would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force four-byte
1150 alignment for the whole structure. (The alignment used may not be four
1151 bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1152
1153 If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1154 a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1155
1156 Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
1157 bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary. The compiler can
1158 support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1159 @samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1160
1161 The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
1162 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1163 Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1164
1165 Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
1166 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1167 @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1168
1169 If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
1170 bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
1171 what the other compiler does. Compile and run this program:
1172
1173 @example
1174 struct foo1
1175 @{
1176 char x;
1177 char :0;
1178 char y;
1179 @};
1180
1181 struct foo2
1182 @{
1183 char x;
1184 int :0;
1185 char y;
1186 @};
1187
1188 main ()
1189 @{
1190 printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1191 sizeof (struct foo1));
1192 printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1193 sizeof (struct foo2));
1194 exit (0);
1195 @}
1196 @end example
1197
1198 If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1199 get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
1200
1201 @findex BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1202 @item BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1203 Like PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS except that its effect is limited to
1204 aligning a bit-field within the structure.
1205
1206 @findex MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK
1207 @item MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (@var{field})
1208 Return 1 if a structure or array containing @var{field} should be accessed using
1209 @code{BLKMODE}.
1210
1211 Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{c4x.h} for an example
1212 of how to use this macro to prevent a structure having a floating point
1213 field from being accessed in an integer mode.
1214
1215 @findex ROUND_TYPE_SIZE
1216 @item ROUND_TYPE_SIZE (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1217 Define this macro as an expression for the overall size of a type
1218 (given by @var{type} as a tree node) when the size computed in the
1219 usual way is @var{computed} and the alignment is @var{specified}.
1220
1221 The default is to round @var{computed} up to a multiple of @var{specified}.
1222
1223 @findex ROUND_TYPE_SIZE_UNIT
1224 @item ROUND_TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1225 Similar to @code{ROUND_TYPE_SIZE}, but sizes and alignments are
1226 specified in units (bytes). If you define @code{ROUND_TYPE_SIZE},
1227 you must also define this macro and they must be defined consistently
1228 with each other.
1229
1230 @findex ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN
1231 @item ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1232 Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1233 by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1234 way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
1235 @var{specified}.
1236
1237 The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1238 the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
1239
1240 @findex MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1241 @item MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1242 An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1243 machine mode that should actually be used. All integer machine modes of
1244 this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1245 appropriate sizes. If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1246 (DImode)} is assumed.
1247
1248 @findex VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
1249 @item VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P(@var{mode})
1250 Define this macro to be nonzero if the port is prepared to handle insns
1251 involving vector mode @var{mode}. At the very least, it must have move
1252 patterns for this mode.
1253
1254 @findex STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE
1255 @item STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
1256 If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1257 specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1258 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1259 @var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1260 @code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1261 having its mode specified.
1262
1263 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}. You
1264 would most commonly define this macro if the
1265 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
1266 64-bit mode.
1267
1268 @findex STACK_SIZE_MODE
1269 @item STACK_SIZE_MODE
1270 If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1271 specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1272 @code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1273
1274 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1275 You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1276 pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
1277
1278 @findex CHECK_FLOAT_VALUE
1279 @item CHECK_FLOAT_VALUE (@var{mode}, @var{value}, @var{overflow})
1280 A C statement to validate the value @var{value} (of type
1281 @code{double}) for mode @var{mode}. This means that you check whether
1282 @var{value} fits within the possible range of values for mode
1283 @var{mode} on this target machine. The mode @var{mode} is always
1284 a mode of class @code{MODE_FLOAT}. @var{overflow} is nonzero if
1285 the value is already known to be out of range.
1286
1287 If @var{value} is not valid or if @var{overflow} is nonzero, you should
1288 set @var{overflow} to 1 and then assign some valid value to @var{value}.
1289 Allowing an invalid value to go through the compiler can produce
1290 incorrect assembler code which may even cause Unix assemblers to crash.
1291
1292 This macro need not be defined if there is no work for it to do.
1293
1294 @findex TARGET_FLOAT_FORMAT
1295 @item TARGET_FLOAT_FORMAT
1296 A code distinguishing the floating point format of the target machine.
1297 There are three defined values:
1298
1299 @table @code
1300 @findex IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT
1301 @item IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT
1302 This code indicates IEEE floating point. It is the default; there is no
1303 need to define this macro when the format is IEEE@.
1304
1305 @findex VAX_FLOAT_FORMAT
1306 @item VAX_FLOAT_FORMAT
1307 This code indicates the peculiar format used on the Vax.
1308
1309 @findex UNKNOWN_FLOAT_FORMAT
1310 @item UNKNOWN_FLOAT_FORMAT
1311 This code indicates any other format.
1312 @end table
1313
1314 The value of this macro is compared with @code{HOST_FLOAT_FORMAT}
1315 (@pxref{Config}) to determine whether the target machine has the same
1316 format as the host machine. If any other formats are actually in use on
1317 supported machines, new codes should be defined for them.
1318
1319 The ordering of the component words of floating point values stored in
1320 memory is controlled by @code{FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} for the target
1321 machine and @code{HOST_FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} for the host.
1322
1323 @end table
1324
1325 @node Type Layout
1326 @section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1327
1328 These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1329 basic data types used in programs being compiled. Unlike the macros in
1330 the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1331 languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1332
1333 @table @code
1334 @findex INT_TYPE_SIZE
1335 @item INT_TYPE_SIZE
1336 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1337 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1338
1339 @findex MAX_INT_TYPE_SIZE
1340 @item MAX_INT_TYPE_SIZE
1341 Maximum number for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the target
1342 machine. If this is undefined, the default is @code{INT_TYPE_SIZE}.
1343 Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the largest value that
1344 @code{INT_TYPE_SIZE} can have at run-time. This is used in @code{cpp}.
1345
1346 @findex SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1347 @item SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1348 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1349 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1350 (If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1351 unit.)
1352
1353 @findex LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1354 @item LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1355 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1356 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1357
1358 @findex MAX_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1359 @item MAX_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1360 Maximum number for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1361 target machine. If this is undefined, the default is
1362 @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
1363 largest value that @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE} can have at run-time. This is
1364 used in @code{cpp}.
1365
1366 @findex LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1367 @item LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1368 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1369 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1370 words. If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
1371 macro must be at least 64.
1372
1373 @findex CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1374 @item CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1375 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1376 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1377 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1378
1379 @findex MAX_CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1380 @item MAX_CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1381 Maximum number for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1382 target machine. If this is undefined, the default is
1383 @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
1384 largest value that @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE} can have at run-time. This is
1385 used in @code{cpp}.
1386
1387 @findex FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1388 @item FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1389 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1390 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1391
1392 @findex DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1393 @item DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1394 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1395 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1396 words.
1397
1398 @findex LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1399 @item LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1400 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1401 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1402 words.
1403
1404 @findex MAX_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1405 Maximum number for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on the
1406 target machine. If this is undefined, the default is
1407 @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is
1408 the largest value that @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} can have at run-time.
1409 This is used in @code{cpp}.
1410
1411 @findex INTEL_EXTENDED_IEEE_FORMAT
1412 Define this macro to be 1 if the target machine uses 80-bit floating-point
1413 values with 128-bit size and alignment. This is used in @file{real.c}.
1414
1415 @findex WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1416 @item WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1417 A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1418 supported by the hardware. If you define this macro, you must specify a
1419 value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1420 If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1421 is the default.
1422
1423 @findex DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1424 @item DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1425 An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1426 @code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default. The user can
1427 always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1428 and @option{-funsigned-char}.
1429
1430 @findex DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS
1431 @item DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS
1432 A C expression to determine whether to give an @code{enum} type
1433 only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range of possible values
1434 of that type. A nonzero value means to do that; a zero value means all
1435 @code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1436
1437 If you don't define the macro, the default is 0.
1438
1439 @findex SIZE_TYPE
1440 @item SIZE_TYPE
1441 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1442 for size values. The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1443 contents of the string.
1444
1445 The string can contain more than one keyword. If so, separate them with
1446 spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1447 appropriate, and finally @code{int}. The string must exactly match one
1448 of the data type names defined in the function
1449 @code{init_decl_processing} in the file @file{c-decl.c}. You may not
1450 omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the compiler to
1451 crash on startup.
1452
1453 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1454 int"}.
1455
1456 @findex PTRDIFF_TYPE
1457 @item PTRDIFF_TYPE
1458 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1459 for the result of subtracting two pointers. The typedef name
1460 @code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string. See
1461 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1462
1463 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
1464
1465 @findex WCHAR_TYPE
1466 @item WCHAR_TYPE
1467 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1468 for wide characters. The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1469 the contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1470 information.
1471
1472 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
1473
1474 @findex WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1475 @item WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1476 A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1477 characters. This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1478 @code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
1479
1480 @findex MAX_WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1481 @item MAX_WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1482 Maximum number for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1483 characters. If this is undefined, the default is
1484 @code{WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
1485 largest value that @code{WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE} can have at run-time. This is
1486 used in @code{cpp}.
1487
1488 @findex GCOV_TYPE_SIZE
1489 @item GCOV_TYPE_SIZE
1490 A C expression for the size in bits of the type used for gcov counters on the
1491 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one
1492 @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE} in case it is greater or equal to 64-bit and
1493 @code{LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE} otherwise. You may want to re-define the type to
1494 ensure atomicity for counters in multithreaded programs.
1495
1496 @findex WINT_TYPE
1497 @item WINT_TYPE
1498 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1499 use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1500 @code{getwc}. The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1501 contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1502 information.
1503
1504 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
1505
1506 @findex INTMAX_TYPE
1507 @item INTMAX_TYPE
1508 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1509 can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1510 The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1511 string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1512
1513 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1514 @code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1515 much precision as @code{long long int}.
1516
1517 @findex UINTMAX_TYPE
1518 @item UINTMAX_TYPE
1519 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1520 can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1521 type. The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1522 of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1523
1524 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1525 @code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1526 unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1527 int}.
1528
1529 @findex OBJC_SELECTORS_WITHOUT_LABELS
1530 @item OBJC_SELECTORS_WITHOUT_LABELS
1531 Define this macro if the compiler can group all the selectors together
1532 into a vector and use just one label at the beginning of the vector.
1533 Otherwise, the compiler must give each selector its own assembler
1534 label.
1535
1536 On certain machines, it is important to have a separate label for each
1537 selector because this enables the linker to eliminate duplicate selectors.
1538
1539 @findex TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1540 @item TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1541 The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1542 that looks like:
1543
1544 @example
1545 struct @{
1546 union @{
1547 void (*fn)();
1548 ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1549 @};
1550 ptrdiff_t delta;
1551 @};
1552 @end example
1553
1554 @noindent
1555 The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1556 will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1557 Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1558 always be zero. Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1559 distinguish which variant of the union is in use. But, on some
1560 platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work. In
1561 that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1562 the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1563
1564 GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1565 this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1566 However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1567 set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1568 bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1569 address is in ARM or Thumb mode. If this is the case of your
1570 architecture, you should define this macro to
1571 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1572
1573 In general, you should not have to define this macro. On architectures
1574 in which function addresses are always even, according to
1575 @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1576 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
1577 @end table
1578
1579 @node Escape Sequences
1580 @section Target Character Escape Sequences
1581 @cindex escape sequences
1582
1583 By default, GCC assumes that the C character escape sequences take on
1584 their ASCII values for the target. If this is not correct, you must
1585 explicitly define all of the macros below.
1586
1587 @table @code
1588 @findex TARGET_BELL
1589 @item TARGET_BELL
1590 A C constant expression for the integer value for escape sequence
1591 @samp{\a}.
1592
1593 @findex TARGET_ESC
1594 @item TARGET_ESC
1595 A C constant expression for the integer value of the target escape
1596 character. As an extension, GCC evaluates the escape sequences
1597 @samp{\e} and @samp{\E} to this.
1598
1599 @findex TARGET_TAB
1600 @findex TARGET_BS
1601 @findex TARGET_NEWLINE
1602 @item TARGET_BS
1603 @itemx TARGET_TAB
1604 @itemx TARGET_NEWLINE
1605 C constant expressions for the integer values for escape sequences
1606 @samp{\b}, @samp{\t} and @samp{\n}.
1607
1608 @findex TARGET_VT
1609 @findex TARGET_FF
1610 @findex TARGET_CR
1611 @item TARGET_VT
1612 @itemx TARGET_FF
1613 @itemx TARGET_CR
1614 C constant expressions for the integer values for escape sequences
1615 @samp{\v}, @samp{\f} and @samp{\r}.
1616 @end table
1617
1618 @node Registers
1619 @section Register Usage
1620 @cindex register usage
1621
1622 This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1623 has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1624
1625 The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1626 done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}. For information
1627 on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1628 For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1629 For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1630
1631 @menu
1632 * Register Basics:: Number and kinds of registers.
1633 * Allocation Order:: Order in which registers are allocated.
1634 * Values in Registers:: What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1635 * Leaf Functions:: Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1636 * Stack Registers:: Handling a register stack such as 80387.
1637 @end menu
1638
1639 @node Register Basics
1640 @subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1641
1642 @c prevent bad page break with this line
1643 Registers have various characteristics.
1644
1645 @table @code
1646 @findex FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1647 @item FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1648 Number of hardware registers known to the compiler. They receive
1649 numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1650 pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1651 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
1652
1653 @item FIXED_REGISTERS
1654 @findex FIXED_REGISTERS
1655 @cindex fixed register
1656 An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1657 all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1658 general allocation. These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1659 pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1660 register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1661 machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1662 and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1663
1664 This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1665 commas and surrounded by braces. The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1666 register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1667
1668 The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1669 the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1670 by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
1671 the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1672 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
1673
1674 @findex CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1675 @item CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1676 @cindex call-used register
1677 @cindex call-clobbered register
1678 @cindex call-saved register
1679 Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1680 clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1681 registers. This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1682 available for general allocation of values that must live across
1683 function calls.
1684
1685 If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1686 automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1687 exit, if the register is used within the function.
1688
1689 @findex HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED
1690 @item HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1691 @cindex call-used register
1692 @cindex call-clobbered register
1693 @cindex call-saved register
1694 A C expression that is non-zero if it is not permissible to store a
1695 value of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} across a
1696 call without some part of it being clobbered. For most machines this
1697 macro need not be defined. It is only required for machines that do not
1698 preserve the entire contents of a register across a call.
1699
1700 @findex CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE
1701 @findex fixed_regs
1702 @findex call_used_regs
1703 @item CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE
1704 Zero or more C statements that may conditionally modify five variables
1705 @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
1706 (these three are of type @code{char []}), @code{reg_names} (of type
1707 @code{const char * []}) and @code{reg_class_contents} (of type
1708 @code{HARD_REG_SET}).
1709 Before the macro is called @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}
1710 @code{reg_class_contents} and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
1711 from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
1712 @code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS} and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively,
1713 @code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1714 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}} command
1715 options have been applied.
1716
1717 This is necessary in case the fixed or call-clobbered registers depend
1718 on target flags.
1719
1720 You need not define this macro if it has no work to do.
1721
1722 @cindex disabling certain registers
1723 @cindex controlling register usage
1724 If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
1725 flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
1726 @code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
1727 registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@. Also define
1728 the macro @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} to return @code{NO_REGS} if it
1729 is called with a letter for a class that shouldn't be used.
1730
1731 (However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
1732 of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
1733 controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
1734 these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
1735
1736 @findex NON_SAVING_SETJMP
1737 @item NON_SAVING_SETJMP
1738 If this macro is defined and has a nonzero value, it means that
1739 @code{setjmp} and related functions fail to save the registers, or that
1740 @code{longjmp} fails to restore them. To compensate, the compiler
1741 avoids putting variables in registers in functions that use
1742 @code{setjmp}.
1743
1744 @findex INCOMING_REGNO
1745 @item INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
1746 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1747 expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
1748 corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
1749 function. Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
1750 outbound register.
1751
1752 @findex OUTGOING_REGNO
1753 @item OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
1754 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1755 expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
1756 corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
1757 function. Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
1758 register.
1759
1760 @findex LOCAL_REGNO
1761 @item LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
1762 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1763 expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
1764 register window. Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
1765 need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
1766 gotos.
1767
1768 @ignore
1769 @findex PC_REGNUM
1770 @item PC_REGNUM
1771 If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
1772 register number. Otherwise, do not define it.
1773 @end ignore
1774 @end table
1775
1776 @node Allocation Order
1777 @subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
1778 @cindex order of register allocation
1779 @cindex register allocation order
1780
1781 @c prevent bad page break with this line
1782 Registers are allocated in order.
1783
1784 @table @code
1785 @findex REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1786 @item REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1787 If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
1788 numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
1789 to use them (from most preferred to least).
1790
1791 If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
1792 (all else being equal).
1793
1794 One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
1795 registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
1796 instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers. On such
1797 machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
1798 the highest numbered allocable register first.
1799
1800 @findex ORDER_REGS_FOR_LOCAL_ALLOC
1801 @item ORDER_REGS_FOR_LOCAL_ALLOC
1802 A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
1803 hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
1804
1805 Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
1806 Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
1807 register; and so on.
1808
1809 The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
1810 @code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
1811
1812 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
1813 @end table
1814
1815 @node Values in Registers
1816 @subsection How Values Fit in Registers
1817
1818 This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
1819 (specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
1820 consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
1821
1822 @table @code
1823 @findex HARD_REGNO_NREGS
1824 @item HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1825 A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
1826 at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
1827 @var{mode}.
1828
1829 On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
1830 definition of this macro is
1831
1832 @smallexample
1833 #define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE) \
1834 ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) \
1835 / UNITS_PER_WORD)
1836 @end smallexample
1837
1838 @findex HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK
1839 @item HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1840 A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
1841 of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
1842 registers starting with that one). For a machine where all registers
1843 are equivalent, a suitable definition is
1844
1845 @smallexample
1846 #define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
1847 @end smallexample
1848
1849 You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
1850 because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
1851
1852 @cindex register pairs
1853 On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
1854 register pairs. You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
1855 odd register numbers for such modes.
1856
1857 The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
1858 @samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
1859 register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
1860 value into the register and back out not alter it.
1861
1862 Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
1863 all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
1864 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
1865 you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This
1866 is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
1867 and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
1868 to be tieable.
1869
1870 Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
1871 Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
1872 in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that
1873 can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
1874 mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
1875 registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
1876
1877 On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
1878 modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating
1879 registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
1880 non-floating value there would garble it. In this case,
1881 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
1882 floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically
1883 normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
1884 unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
1885 register, so you can define this macro to say so.
1886
1887 The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
1888 they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
1889 instructions. However, this is of no concern to
1890 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper
1891 constraints for those instructions.
1892
1893 On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
1894 so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
1895 register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the
1896 floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
1897 be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
1898
1899 @findex MODES_TIEABLE_P
1900 @item MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
1901 A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
1902 @var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
1903
1904 If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
1905 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
1906 any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
1907 should be nonzero. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
1908 this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
1909 accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
1910
1911 You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
1912 possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
1913 allocation.
1914
1915 @findex AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
1916 @item AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
1917 Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
1918 registers. You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
1919 @code{CCmode} is incomplete.
1920
1921 @findex SUBREG_REGNO_OFFSET
1922 @item SUBREG_REGNO_OFFSET
1923 Define this macro if the compiler needs to handle subregs in a non-standard
1924 way. The macro returns the correct regno offset for mode @code{YMODE} given
1925 a subreg of type @code{XMODE}.
1926 This macro takes 4 parameters:
1927 @table @code
1928 @item XREGNO
1929 A regno of an inner hard subreg_reg (or what will become one).
1930 @item XMODE
1931 The mode of xregno.
1932 @item OFFSET
1933 The byte offset.
1934 @item YMODE
1935 The mode of a top level SUBREG (or what may become one).
1936 @end table
1937 The default function can be found in @file{rtlanal.c}, function
1938 @code{subreg_regno_offset}. Normally this does not need to be defined.
1939 @end table
1940
1941 @node Leaf Functions
1942 @subsection Handling Leaf Functions
1943
1944 @cindex leaf functions
1945 @cindex functions, leaf
1946 On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
1947 more efficiently if it does not make its own register window. Often this
1948 means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
1949 are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
1950 normally arrive.
1951
1952 The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
1953 other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
1954 registers for its own variables and temporaries. We use the term ``leaf
1955 function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
1956 handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
1957 functions''.
1958
1959 GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
1960 suitable for leaf function treatment. So it needs to renumber the
1961 registers in order to output a leaf function. The following macros
1962 accomplish this.
1963
1964 @table @code
1965 @findex LEAF_REGISTERS
1966 @item LEAF_REGISTERS
1967 Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
1968 contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
1969 function treatment.
1970
1971 If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
1972 registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
1973 GCC would ordinarily allocate. The registers which will actually be
1974 used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
1975 in this vector.
1976
1977 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
1978 the treatment of leaf functions.
1979
1980 @findex LEAF_REG_REMAP
1981 @item LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
1982 A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
1983 should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
1984
1985 If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
1986 function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
1987 will cause the compiler to abort.
1988
1989 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
1990 treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
1991 this.
1992 @end table
1993
1994 @findex current_function_is_leaf
1995 @findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
1996 Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
1997 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
1998 They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} which is
1999 nonzero for leaf functions. @code{current_function_is_leaf} is set
2000 prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
2001 compiler passes. They can also test the C variable
2002 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2003 functions which only use leaf registers.
2004 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after reload and is
2005 only useful if @code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
2006 @c changed this to fix overfull. ALSO: why the "it" at the beginning
2007 @c of the next paragraph?! --mew 2feb93
2008
2009 @node Stack Registers
2010 @subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2011
2012 There are special features to handle computers where some of the
2013 ``registers'' form a stack, as in the 80387 coprocessor for the 80386.
2014 Stack registers are normally written by pushing onto the stack, and are
2015 numbered relative to the top of the stack.
2016
2017 Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
2018 they must be consecutively numbered.
2019
2020 @table @code
2021 @findex STACK_REGS
2022 @item STACK_REGS
2023 Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
2024
2025 @findex FIRST_STACK_REG
2026 @item FIRST_STACK_REG
2027 The number of the first stack-like register. This one is the top
2028 of the stack.
2029
2030 @findex LAST_STACK_REG
2031 @item LAST_STACK_REG
2032 The number of the last stack-like register. This one is the bottom of
2033 the stack.
2034 @end table
2035
2036 @node Register Classes
2037 @section Register Classes
2038 @cindex register class definitions
2039 @cindex class definitions, register
2040
2041 On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2042 For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2043 certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions. These machine
2044 restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2045
2046 You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2047 which of the registers belong to it. Then you can specify register classes
2048 that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2049
2050 @findex ALL_REGS
2051 @findex NO_REGS
2052 In general, each register will belong to several classes. In fact, one
2053 class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers. Another
2054 class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers. Often the
2055 union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2056
2057 @findex GENERAL_REGS
2058 One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}. There is nothing
2059 terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2060 @samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class. If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2061 the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2062 to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2063
2064 Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2065 then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2066
2067 The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2068 constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2069 You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2070 them in operand constraints.
2071
2072 You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2073 instruction allows both classes. For example, if an instruction allows
2074 either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2075 certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
2076 which includes both of them. Otherwise you will get suboptimal code.
2077
2078 You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2079 classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2080 contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2081 in their union.
2082
2083 When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2084 certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2085 Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2086 a register pair to start with an even-numbered register. The way to
2087 specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2088
2089 Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2090 instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2091 each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2092 mode to or from memory. For example, on some machines, the operations for
2093 single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers. When
2094 this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2095 instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2096 single-byte values can be loaded or stored. This is so that
2097 @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2098
2099 @table @code
2100 @findex enum reg_class
2101 @item enum reg_class
2102 An enumeral type that must be defined with all the register class names
2103 as enumeral values. @code{NO_REGS} must be first. @code{ALL_REGS}
2104 must be the last register class, followed by one more enumeral value,
2105 @code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2106 tells how many classes there are.
2107
2108 Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2109 the class name to type @code{int}. The number serves as an index
2110 in many of the tables described below.
2111
2112 @findex N_REG_CLASSES
2113 @item N_REG_CLASSES
2114 The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2115
2116 @example
2117 #define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
2118 @end example
2119
2120 @findex REG_CLASS_NAMES
2121 @item REG_CLASS_NAMES
2122 An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2123 constants. These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
2124
2125 @findex REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2126 @item REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2127 An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2128 which are bit masks. The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2129 @var{n}. The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2130 register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2131
2132 When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2133 Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2134 several integers. Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2135 for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
2136 In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2137 registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2138 so on.
2139
2140 @findex REGNO_REG_CLASS
2141 @item REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
2142 A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2143 @var{regno}. In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2144 which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2145 register.
2146
2147 @findex BASE_REG_CLASS
2148 @item BASE_REG_CLASS
2149 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2150 base register must belong. A base register is one used in an address
2151 which is the register value plus a displacement.
2152
2153 @findex INDEX_REG_CLASS
2154 @item INDEX_REG_CLASS
2155 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2156 index register must belong. An index register is one used in an
2157 address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2158 added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
2159
2160 @findex REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER
2161 @item REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER (@var{char})
2162 A C expression which defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2163 letters for register classes. If @var{char} is such a letter, the
2164 value should be the register class corresponding to it. Otherwise,
2165 the value should be @code{NO_REGS}. The register letter @samp{r},
2166 corresponding to class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, will not be passed
2167 to this macro; you do not need to handle it.
2168
2169 @findex REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P
2170 @item REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
2171 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2172 suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses. It may be
2173 either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2174 allocated such a hard register.
2175
2176 @findex REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P
2177 @item REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2178 A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2179 that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2180 @var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2181 reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
2182 you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
2183 @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
2184
2185 @findex REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P
2186 @item REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
2187 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2188 suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses. It may be
2189 either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2190 allocated such a hard register.
2191
2192 The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2193 the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
2194 two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2195 labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2196 labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2197 may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
2198 looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2199 only if neither labeling works.
2200
2201 @findex PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS
2202 @item PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2203 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2204 to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2205 @var{class}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2206 another, smaller class. On many machines, the following definition is
2207 safe:
2208
2209 @example
2210 #define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
2211 @end example
2212
2213 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2214 example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2215 for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2216 @code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2217 Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2218
2219 If @var{x} is a @code{const_double}, by returning @code{NO_REGS}
2220 you can force @var{x} into a memory constant. This is useful on
2221 certain machines where immediate floating values cannot be loaded into
2222 certain kinds of registers.
2223
2224 @findex PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
2225 @item PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2226 Like @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2227 input reloads. If you don't define this macro, the default is to use
2228 @var{class}, unchanged.
2229
2230 @findex LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS
2231 @item LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
2232 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2233 to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2234 @var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2235 ordinarily be used.
2236
2237 Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2238 there are certain modes that simply can't go in certain reload classes.
2239
2240 The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2241 smaller class.
2242
2243 Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2244 require the macro to do something nontrivial.
2245
2246 @findex SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS
2247 @findex SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
2248 @findex SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
2249 @item SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2250 @itemx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2251 @itemx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2252 Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2253 from memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the
2254 @samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
2255 from general registers, but not memory. Some machines allow copying all
2256 registers to and from memory, but require a scratch register for stores
2257 to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic address on the RT,
2258 and those with certain symbolic address on the Sparc when compiling
2259 PIC)@. In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are
2260 required.
2261
2262 You should define these macros to indicate to the reload phase that it may
2263 need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2264 register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2265 register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
2266 you should define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
2267 largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2268 intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2269
2270 If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2271 intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
2272 should be defined to return the largest register class required. If the
2273 requirements for input and output reloads are the same, the macro
2274 @code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should be used instead of defining both
2275 macros identically.
2276
2277 The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2278 Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2279 can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2280 @var{mode} without requiring a scratch register. Do not define this
2281 macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2282
2283 If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
2284 intermediate register), you should define patterns for
2285 @samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
2286 (@pxref{Standard Names}. These patterns, which will normally be
2287 implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2288 @samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2289 register.
2290
2291 Define constraints for the reload register and scratch register that
2292 contain a single register class. If the original reload register (whose
2293 class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2294 value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2295 register. Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2296 Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2297
2298 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2299 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2300 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2301 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2302
2303 These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2304 registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2305 registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2306 would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
2307 the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as a
2308 intermediate storage. This case often occurs between floating-point and
2309 general registers.
2310
2311 @findex SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED
2312 @item SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
2313 Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2314 to some other registers without using memory. Define this macro on
2315 those machines to be a C expression that is non-zero if objects of mode
2316 @var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
2317 class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
2318 and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
2319
2320 Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
2321
2322 @findex SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX
2323 @item SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
2324 Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2325 allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2326 If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2327 defined by this macro.
2328
2329 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2330 @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
2331
2332 @findex SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE
2333 @item SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
2334 When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
2335 registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
2336 hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
2337 load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
2338 same as that of @var{mode}.
2339
2340 This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
2341 bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
2342 in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
2343 registers.
2344
2345 However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2346 the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2347 differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default
2348 widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
2349 suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.h} for
2350 details.
2351
2352 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2353 @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
2354 is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
2355
2356 @findex SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES
2357 @item SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES
2358 On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
2359 insns. Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
2360 to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
2361 if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
2362 insn.
2363
2364 Define @code{SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES} to be an expression with a non-zero
2365 value on these machines. When this macro has a non-zero value, the
2366 compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of hard registers.
2367
2368 It is always safe to define this macro with a non-zero value, but if you
2369 unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
2370 that can be performed in some cases. If you do not define this macro
2371 with a non-zero value when it is required, the compiler will run out of
2372 spill registers and print a fatal error message. For most machines, you
2373 should not define this macro at all.
2374
2375 @findex CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P
2376 @item CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P (@var{class})
2377 A C expression whose value is nonzero if pseudos that have been assigned
2378 to registers of class @var{class} would likely be spilled because
2379 registers of @var{class} are needed for spill registers.
2380
2381 The default value of this macro returns 1 if @var{class} has exactly one
2382 register and zero otherwise. On most machines, this default should be
2383 used. Only define this macro to some other expression if pseudos
2384 allocated by @file{local-alloc.c} end up in memory because their hard
2385 registers were needed for spill registers. If this macro returns nonzero
2386 for those classes, those pseudos will only be allocated by
2387 @file{global.c}, which knows how to reallocate the pseudo to another
2388 register. If there would not be another register available for
2389 reallocation, you should not change the definition of this macro since
2390 the only effect of such a definition would be to slow down register
2391 allocation.
2392
2393 @findex CLASS_MAX_NREGS
2394 @item CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
2395 A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2396 of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2397
2398 This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2399 the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2400 should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2401 @var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2402
2403 This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2404 in the reload pass.
2405
2406 @item CLASS_CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE
2407 If defined, a C expression for a class that contains registers for
2408 which the compiler may not change modes arbitrarily.
2409
2410 @item CLASS_CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_P(@var{from}, @var{to})
2411 A C expression that is true if, for a register in
2412 @code{CLASS_CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE}, the requested mode punning is illegal.
2413
2414 For the example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
2415 floating-point registers on the Alpha extends them to 64-bits.
2416 Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
2417 does not store the low-order 32-bits, as would be the case for a normal
2418 register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CLASS_CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE}
2419 as @code{FLOAT_REGS} and @code{CLASS_CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_P} restricts
2420 mode changes to same-size modes.
2421
2422 Compare this to IA-64, which extends floating-point values to 82-bits,
2423 and stores 64-bit integers in a different format than 64-bit doubles.
2424 Therefore @code{CLASS_CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_P} is always true.
2425 @end table
2426
2427 Three other special macros describe which operands fit which constraint
2428 letters.
2429
2430 @table @code
2431 @findex CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P
2432 @item CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2433 A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2434 letters (@samp{I}, @samp{J}, @samp{K}, @dots{} @samp{P}) that specify
2435 particular ranges of integer values. If @var{c} is one of those
2436 letters, the expression should check that @var{value}, an integer, is in
2437 the appropriate range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is
2438 not one of those letters, the value should be 0 regardless of
2439 @var{value}.
2440
2441 @findex CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P
2442 @item CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2443 A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2444 letters that specify particular ranges of @code{const_double} values
2445 (@samp{G} or @samp{H}).
2446
2447 If @var{c} is one of those letters, the expression should check that
2448 @var{value}, an RTX of code @code{const_double}, is in the appropriate
2449 range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is not one of those
2450 letters, the value should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2451
2452 @code{const_double} is used for all floating-point constants and for
2453 @code{DImode} fixed-point constants. A given letter can accept either
2454 or both kinds of values. It can use @code{GET_MODE} to distinguish
2455 between these kinds.
2456
2457 @findex EXTRA_CONSTRAINT
2458 @item EXTRA_CONSTRAINT (@var{value}, @var{c})
2459 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2460 letters that can be used to segregate specific types of operands, usually
2461 memory references, for the target machine. Any letter that is not
2462 elsewhere defined and not matched by @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER}
2463 may be used. Normally this macro will not be defined.
2464
2465 If it is required for a particular target machine, it should return 1
2466 if @var{value} corresponds to the operand type represented by the
2467 constraint letter @var{c}. If @var{c} is not defined as an extra
2468 constraint, the value returned should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2469
2470 For example, on the ROMP, load instructions cannot have their output
2471 in r0 if the memory reference contains a symbolic address. Constraint
2472 letter @samp{Q} is defined as representing a memory address that does
2473 @emph{not} contain a symbolic address. An alternative is specified with
2474 a @samp{Q} constraint on the input and @samp{r} on the output. The next
2475 alternative specifies @samp{m} on the input and a register class that
2476 does not include r0 on the output.
2477 @end table
2478
2479 @node Stack and Calling
2480 @section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
2481 @cindex calling conventions
2482
2483 @c prevent bad page break with this line
2484 This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
2485
2486 @menu
2487 * Frame Layout::
2488 * Exception Handling::
2489 * Stack Checking::
2490 * Frame Registers::
2491 * Elimination::
2492 * Stack Arguments::
2493 * Register Arguments::
2494 * Scalar Return::
2495 * Aggregate Return::
2496 * Caller Saves::
2497 * Function Entry::
2498 * Profiling::
2499 * Inlining::
2500 * Tail Calling::
2501 @end menu
2502
2503 @node Frame Layout
2504 @subsection Basic Stack Layout
2505 @cindex stack frame layout
2506 @cindex frame layout
2507
2508 @c prevent bad page break with this line
2509 Here is the basic stack layout.
2510
2511 @table @code
2512 @findex STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2513 @item STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2514 Define this macro if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
2515 pointer to a smaller address.
2516
2517 When we say, ``define this macro if @dots{},'' it means that the
2518 compiler checks this macro only with @code{#ifdef} so the precise
2519 definition used does not matter.
2520
2521 @findex STACK_PUSH_CODE
2522 @item STACK_PUSH_CODE
2523
2524 This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
2525 on the stack. In RTL, a push operation will be
2526 @code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) ...)}
2527
2528 The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
2529 and @code{POST_INC}. Which of these is correct depends on
2530 the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
2531 to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
2532 space for the next item on the stack.
2533
2534 The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
2535 defined, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
2536 which is often wrong.
2537
2538 @findex FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2539 @item FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2540 Define this macro if the addresses of local variable slots are at negative
2541 offsets from the frame pointer.
2542
2543 @findex ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
2544 @item ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
2545 Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
2546 addresses on the stack.
2547
2548 @findex STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
2549 @item STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
2550 Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
2551
2552 If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
2553 subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
2554 Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
2555 value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
2556 @c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
2557 @c rid of an overfull. --mew 2feb93
2558
2559 @findex STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
2560 @item STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
2561 Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
2562 outgoing arguments are placed. If not specified, the default value of
2563 zero is used. This is the proper value for most machines.
2564
2565 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
2566 the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
2567
2568 @findex FIRST_PARM_OFFSET
2569 @item FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
2570 Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
2571 address. On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
2572 function.
2573
2574 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
2575 the first argument's address.
2576
2577 @findex STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET
2578 @item STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
2579 Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
2580 on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
2581
2582 The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
2583 length of the outgoing arguments. The default is correct for most
2584 machines. See @file{function.c} for details.
2585
2586 @findex DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS
2587 @item DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
2588 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
2589 frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that
2590 @var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
2591 itself.
2592
2593 If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
2594 of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
2595 address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
2596
2597 @findex SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
2598 @item SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
2599 If defined, a C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
2600 setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed. For example,
2601 on the Sparc, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
2602 before we can access arbitrary stack frames. You will seldom need to
2603 define this macro.
2604
2605 @findex BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE
2606 @item BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE
2607 If defined, a C expression that contains an rtx that is used to store
2608 the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
2609 The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
2610 machines. One reason you may need to define this macro is if
2611 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
2612
2613 @findex RETURN_ADDR_RTX
2614 @item RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
2615 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
2616 address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
2617 the prologue. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
2618 frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
2619 @code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is defined.
2620
2621 The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
2622 @var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is not way to
2623 determine the return address of other frames.
2624
2625 @findex RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
2626 @item RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
2627 Define this if the return address of a particular stack frame is accessed
2628 from the frame pointer of the previous stack frame.
2629
2630 @findex INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
2631 @item INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
2632 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
2633 incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
2634 prologue. This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
2635 value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
2636 the stack.
2637
2638 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
2639 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
2640
2641 If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
2642 @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
2643
2644 @findex INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
2645 @item INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
2646 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
2647 from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
2648 frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue. The top of
2649 the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
2650 previous frame, just before the call instruction.
2651
2652 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
2653 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
2654
2655 @findex ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
2656 @item ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
2657 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
2658 from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa). The
2659 final value should coincide with that calculated by
2660 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}. Which is unfortunately not usable
2661 during virtual register instantiation.
2662
2663 The default value for this macro is @code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl)},
2664 which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
2665 immediately before the stack frame. Note that this is not the case on
2666 some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
2667 and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
2668
2669 You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
2670 want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
2671 DWARF 2.
2672
2673 @findex SMALL_STACK
2674 @item SMALL_STACK
2675 Define this macro if the stack size for the target is very small. This
2676 has the effect of disabling gcc's built-in @samp{alloca}, though
2677 @samp{__builtin_alloca} is not affected.
2678 @end table
2679
2680 @node Exception Handling
2681 @subsection Exception Handling Support
2682 @cindex exception handling
2683
2684 @table @code
2685 @findex EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO
2686 @item EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
2687 A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
2688 data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
2689 @var{N} registers are usable.
2690
2691 The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
2692 handlers via a set of agreed upon registers. Ideally these registers
2693 should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
2694 but may negatively impact code size. The target must support at least
2695 2 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
2696
2697 You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
2698 handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
2699
2700 @findex EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
2701 @item EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
2702 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
2703 to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
2704 This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
2705 It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
2706
2707 Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
2708 untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
2709
2710 You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
2711 handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
2712
2713 @findex EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
2714 @item EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
2715 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
2716 to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
2717 return. It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
2718
2719 Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
2720 return address is stored. For targets that return by popping an
2721 address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
2722 the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
2723 frame. @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already been assigned,
2724 so it may be used to calculate the location of the target call frame.
2725
2726 Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
2727 address calculable during initial code generation. In that case
2728 the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
2729
2730 If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
2731 define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
2732
2733 @findex ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT
2734 @item ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT(@var{code}, @var{global})
2735 This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
2736 handling sections. If at all possible, this should be defined such
2737 that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
2738 and so may be read-only.
2739
2740 @var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
2741 @var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
2742 The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
2743 as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
2744
2745 If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
2746 represented directly.
2747
2748 @findex ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX
2749 @item ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX(@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
2750 This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
2751 to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
2752 Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
2753 be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
2754
2755 This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
2756 handled. @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
2757 of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
2758 to be emitted.
2759
2760 @findex MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR
2761 @item MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR(@var{context}, @var{fs}, @var{success})
2762 This macro allows the target to add cpu and operating system specific
2763 code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
2764 available. The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
2765 through signal frames.
2766
2767 This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in @file{unwind-dw2.c}
2768 and @file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
2769 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{context->ra}
2770 for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
2771 the stack pointer value. If the frame can be decoded, the register save
2772 addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should branch to
2773 @var{success}. If the frame cannot be decoded, the macro should do
2774 nothing.
2775 @end table
2776
2777 @node Stack Checking
2778 @subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
2779
2780 GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of
2781 the stack, if the @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of three ways:
2782
2783 @enumerate
2784 @item
2785 If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
2786 will assume that you have arranged for stack checking to be done at
2787 appropriate places in the configuration files, e.g., in
2788 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}. GCC will do not other special
2789 processing.
2790
2791 @item
2792 If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and you defined a named pattern
2793 called @code{check_stack} in your @file{md} file, GCC will call that
2794 pattern with one argument which is the address to compare the stack
2795 value against. You must arrange for this pattern to report an error if
2796 the stack pointer is out of range.
2797
2798 @item
2799 If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
2800 ``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
2801 @end enumerate
2802
2803 Normally, you will use the default values of these macros, so GCC
2804 will use the third approach.
2805
2806 @table @code
2807 @findex STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
2808 @item STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
2809 A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
2810 machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if stack checking
2811 is require by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to have to stack
2812 checking in some more efficient way than GCC's portable approach.
2813 The default value of this macro is zero.
2814
2815 @findex STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL
2816 @item STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL
2817 An integer representing the interval at which GCC must generate stack
2818 probe instructions. You will normally define this macro to be no larger
2819 than the size of the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area. The
2820 default value of 4096 is suitable for most systems.
2821
2822 @findex STACK_CHECK_PROBE_LOAD
2823 @item STACK_CHECK_PROBE_LOAD
2824 A integer which is nonzero if GCC should perform the stack probe
2825 as a load instruction and zero if GCC should use a store instruction.
2826 The default is zero, which is the most efficient choice on most systems.
2827
2828 @findex STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
2829 @item STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
2830 The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow,
2831 for languages where such a recovery is supported. The default value of
2832 75 words should be adequate for most machines.
2833
2834 @findex STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
2835 @item STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
2836 The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes. GCC will generate probe
2837 instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
2838 stack are available. If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
2839 checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning. The
2840 default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
2841 systems. You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
2842
2843 @findex STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
2844 @item STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
2845 GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message. It
2846 represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
2847 space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
2848 You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
2849 use the default of four words.
2850
2851 @findex STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
2852 @item STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
2853 The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
2854 fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
2855 @option{-fstack-check}.
2856 GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
2857 normally not need to override that default.
2858 @end table
2859
2860 @need 2000
2861 @node Frame Registers
2862 @subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
2863
2864 @c prevent bad page break with this line
2865 This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
2866
2867 @table @code
2868 @findex STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
2869 @item STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
2870 The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
2871 fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}. On most machines,
2872 the hardware determines which register this is.
2873
2874 @findex FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
2875 @item FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
2876 The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
2877 access automatic variables in the stack frame. On some machines, the
2878 hardware determines which register this is. On other machines, you can
2879 choose any register you wish for this purpose.
2880
2881 @findex HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
2882 @item HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
2883 On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
2884 offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
2885 allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
2886 between these two locations). On those machines, define
2887 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
2888 be used internally until the offset is known, and define
2889 @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
2890 used for the frame pointer.
2891
2892 You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
2893 is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
2894 the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
2895 completed. When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
2896 definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
2897 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
2898 or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
2899
2900 Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
2901 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
2902
2903 @findex ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
2904 @item ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
2905 The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
2906 the function's argument list. On some machines, this is the same as the
2907 frame pointer register. On some machines, the hardware determines which
2908 register this is. On other machines, you can choose any register you
2909 wish for this purpose. If this is not the same register as the frame
2910 pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
2911 @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
2912 (@pxref{Elimination}).
2913
2914 @findex RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
2915 @item RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
2916 The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
2917 access the current function's return address from the stack. On some
2918 machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
2919 pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer. This register can be defined
2920 to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
2921 @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
2922
2923 Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
2924 address from the stack.
2925
2926 @findex STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
2927 @findex STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
2928 @item STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
2929 @itemx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
2930 Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer. If
2931 register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
2932 function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
2933 number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}. If
2934 these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
2935 not be defined.
2936
2937 The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
2938
2939 If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
2940 defined; instead, the next two macros should be defined.
2941
2942 @findex STATIC_CHAIN
2943 @findex STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING
2944 @item STATIC_CHAIN
2945 @itemx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING
2946 If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros provide rtx giving
2947 @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
2948 @code{STATIC_CHAIN} and @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING} give the locations
2949 as seen by the calling and called functions, respectively. Often the former
2950 will be at an offset from the stack pointer and the latter at an offset from
2951 the frame pointer.
2952
2953 @findex stack_pointer_rtx
2954 @findex frame_pointer_rtx
2955 @findex arg_pointer_rtx
2956 The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
2957 @code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized prior to the use of these
2958 macros and should be used to refer to those items.
2959
2960 If the static chain is passed in a register, the two previous macros should
2961 be defined instead.
2962 @end table
2963
2964 @node Elimination
2965 @subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
2966
2967 @c prevent bad page break with this line
2968 This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
2969
2970 @table @code
2971 @findex FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED
2972 @item FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED
2973 A C expression which is nonzero if a function must have and use a frame
2974 pointer. This expression is evaluated in the reload pass. If its value is
2975 nonzero the function will have a frame pointer.
2976
2977 The expression can in principle examine the current function and decide
2978 according to the facts, but on most machines the constant 0 or the
2979 constant 1 suffices. Use 0 when the machine allows code to be generated
2980 with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space. Use 1
2981 when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame pointer.
2982
2983 In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
2984 without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and
2985 automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
2986 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} says. You don't need to worry about
2987 them.
2988
2989 In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
2990 register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
2991 fixed register. See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
2992
2993 @findex INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET
2994 @findex get_frame_size
2995 @item INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (@var{depth-var})
2996 A C statement to store in the variable @var{depth-var} the difference
2997 between the frame pointer and the stack pointer values immediately after
2998 the function prologue. The value would be computed from information
2999 such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3000 registers @code{regs_ever_live} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3001
3002 If @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is defined, this macro will be not be used and
3003 need not be defined. Otherwise, it must be defined even if
3004 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} is defined to always be true; in that
3005 case, you may set @var{depth-var} to anything.
3006
3007 @findex ELIMINABLE_REGS
3008 @item ELIMINABLE_REGS
3009 If defined, this macro specifies a table of register pairs used to
3010 eliminate unneeded registers that point into the stack frame. If it is not
3011 defined, the only elimination attempted by the compiler is to replace
3012 references to the frame pointer with references to the stack pointer.
3013
3014 The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3015 of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3016
3017 On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3018 the compilation is completed. In such a case, a separate hard register
3019 must be used for the argument pointer. This register can be eliminated by
3020 replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3021 depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3022
3023 In this case, you might specify:
3024 @example
3025 #define ELIMINABLE_REGS \
3026 @{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3027 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3028 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3029 @end example
3030
3031 Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3032 specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
3033
3034 @findex CAN_ELIMINATE
3035 @item CAN_ELIMINATE (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg})
3036 A C expression that returns non-zero if the compiler is allowed to try
3037 to replace register number @var{from-reg} with register number
3038 @var{to-reg}. This macro need only be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS}
3039 is defined, and will usually be the constant 1, since most of the cases
3040 preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3041 knows about.
3042
3043 @findex INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET
3044 @item INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
3045 This macro is similar to @code{INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET}. It
3046 specifies the initial difference between the specified pair of
3047 registers. This macro must be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is
3048 defined.
3049
3050 @findex LONGJMP_RESTORE_FROM_STACK
3051 @item LONGJMP_RESTORE_FROM_STACK
3052 Define this macro if the @code{longjmp} function restores registers from
3053 the stack frames, rather than from those saved specifically by
3054 @code{setjmp}. Certain quantities must not be kept in registers across
3055 a call to @code{setjmp} on such machines.
3056 @end table
3057
3058 @node Stack Arguments
3059 @subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3060 @cindex arguments on stack
3061 @cindex stack arguments
3062
3063 The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3064 on the stack. See the following section for other macros that
3065 control passing certain arguments in registers.
3066
3067 @table @code
3068 @findex PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES
3069 @item PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES
3070 A C expression whose value is nonzero if an argument declared in
3071 a prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should
3072 actually be passed as an @code{int}. In addition to avoiding
3073 errors in certain cases of mismatch, it also makes for better
3074 code on certain machines. If the macro is not defined in target
3075 header files, it defaults to 0.
3076
3077 @findex PUSH_ARGS
3078 @item PUSH_ARGS
3079 A C expression. If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
3080 outgoing arguments.
3081 If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3082 That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3083 allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
3084 it. When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
3085 On some machines, the definition
3086
3087 @findex PUSH_ROUNDING
3088 @item PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
3089 A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3090 stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
3091
3092 On some machines, the definition
3093
3094 @example
3095 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3096 @end example
3097
3098 @noindent
3099 will suffice. But on other machines, instructions that appear
3100 to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3101 alignment. Then the definition should be
3102
3103 @example
3104 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3105 @end example
3106
3107 @findex ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3108 @findex current_function_outgoing_args_size
3109 @item ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3110 A C expression. If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
3111 will be computed and placed into the variable
3112 @code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}. No space will be pushed
3113 onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3114 increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3115
3116 Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
3117 is not proper.
3118
3119 @findex REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
3120 @item REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3121 Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3122 allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3123 registers.
3124
3125 The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
3126 arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
3127 which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
3128
3129 This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3130 machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3131 which.
3132 @c above is overfull. not sure what to do. --mew 5feb93 did
3133 @c something, not sure if it looks good. --mew 10feb93
3134
3135 @findex MAYBE_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
3136 @findex FINAL_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
3137 @item MAYBE_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
3138 @itemx FINAL_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{const_size}, @var{var_size})
3139 Define these macros in addition to the one above if functions might
3140 allocate stack space for arguments even when their values are passed
3141 in registers. These should be used when the stack space allocated
3142 for arguments in registers is not a simple constant independent of the
3143 function declaration.
3144
3145 The value of the first macro is the size, in bytes, of the area that
3146 we should initially assume would be reserved for arguments passed in registers.
3147
3148 The value of the second macro is the actual size, in bytes, of the area
3149 that will be reserved for arguments passed in registers. This takes two
3150 arguments: an integer representing the number of bytes of fixed sized
3151 arguments on the stack, and a tree representing the number of bytes of
3152 variable sized arguments on the stack.
3153
3154 When these macros are defined, @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} will only be
3155 called for libcall functions, the current function, or for a function
3156 being called when it is known that such stack space must be allocated.
3157 In each case this value can be easily computed.
3158
3159 When deciding whether a called function needs such stack space, and how
3160 much space to reserve, GCC uses these two macros instead of
3161 @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}.
3162
3163 @findex OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
3164 @item OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
3165 Define this if it is the responsibility of the caller to allocate the area
3166 reserved for arguments passed in registers.
3167
3168 If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3169 whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
3170 @code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}.
3171
3172 @findex STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3173 @item STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3174 Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3175 stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3176 @c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3177 @c overfull.. not as specific, tho. --mew 5feb93
3178
3179 Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3180 stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area. Defining this macro
3181 suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3182 stack in its natural location.
3183
3184 @findex RETURN_POPS_ARGS
3185 @item RETURN_POPS_ARGS (@var{fundecl}, @var{funtype}, @var{stack-size})
3186 A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes of its own
3187 arguments that a function pops on returning, or 0 if the
3188 function pops no arguments and the caller must therefore pop them all
3189 after the function returns.
3190
3191 @var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3192 the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3193 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
3194 From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_MACHINE_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
3195
3196 @var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3197 describes the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3198 @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3199 From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3200 arguments (if known).
3201
3202 When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
3203 will contain an identifier node for the library function. Thus, if
3204 you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3205 by their names. Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3206 a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3207 in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3208
3209 @var{stack-size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
3210 stack. If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3211 argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
3212
3213 On the Vax, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
3214 of this macro is @var{stack-size}. On the 68000, using the standard
3215 calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
3216 the macro is always 0 in this case. But an alternative calling
3217 convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
3218 arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
3219 nothing (the caller pops all). When this convention is in use,
3220 @var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
3221 number of arguments.
3222 @end table
3223
3224 @node Register Arguments
3225 @subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
3226 @cindex arguments in registers
3227 @cindex registers arguments
3228
3229 This section describes the macros which let you control how various
3230 types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
3231 the stack.
3232
3233 @table @code
3234 @findex FUNCTION_ARG
3235 @item FUNCTION_ARG (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3236 A C expression that controls whether a function argument is passed
3237 in a register, and which register.
3238
3239 The arguments are @var{cum}, which summarizes all the previous
3240 arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
3241 the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
3242 (which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
3243 which is 1 for an ordinary argument and 0 for nameless arguments that
3244 correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called function's prototype.
3245 @var{type} can be an incomplete type if a syntax error has previously
3246 occurred.
3247
3248 The value of the expression is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the
3249 hard register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the
3250 argument on the stack.
3251
3252 For machines like the Vax and 68000, where normally all arguments are
3253 pushed, zero suffices as a definition.
3254
3255 The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@. This is
3256 used when an argument is passed in multiple locations. The mode of the
3257 of the @code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument. The
3258 @code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
3259 describes where part of the argument is passed. In each
3260 @code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3261 register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
3262 register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is. The
3263 second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
3264 the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
3265 As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
3266 RTX may have a first operand of zero. This indicates that the entire
3267 argument is also stored on the stack.
3268
3269 The last time this macro is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
3270 VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
3271 pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
3272
3273 @cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
3274 The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a machine
3275 where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to cause
3276 nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead. This is done
3277 by making @code{FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever @var{named} is 0.
3278
3279 @cindex @code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
3280 @cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
3281 You may use the macro @code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (@var{mode}, @var{type})}
3282 in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
3283 type that must be passed in the stack. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
3284 is not defined and @code{FUNCTION_ARG} returns non-zero for such an
3285 argument, the compiler will abort. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
3286 defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
3287 a register.
3288
3289 @findex MUST_PASS_IN_STACK
3290 @item MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (@var{mode}, @var{type})
3291 Define as a C expression that evaluates to nonzero if we do not know how
3292 to pass TYPE solely in registers. The file @file{expr.h} defines a
3293 definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
3294 documentation.
3295
3296 @findex FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG
3297 @item FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3298 Define this macro if the target machine has ``register windows'', so
3299 that the register in which a function sees an arguments is not
3300 necessarily the same as the one in which the caller passed the
3301 argument.
3302
3303 For such machines, @code{FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in which
3304 the caller passes the value, and @code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should
3305 be defined in a similar fashion to tell the function being called
3306 where the arguments will arrive.
3307
3308 If @code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined, @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
3309 serves both purposes.
3310
3311 @findex FUNCTION_ARG_PARTIAL_NREGS
3312 @item FUNCTION_ARG_PARTIAL_NREGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3313 A C expression for the number of words, at the beginning of an
3314 argument, that must be put in registers. The value must be zero for
3315 arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
3316 pushed on the stack.
3317
3318 On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
3319 registers and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the
3320 first @var{n} words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
3321 on the stack. If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
3322 structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
3323 in registers and the rest must be pushed. This macro tells the
3324 compiler when this occurs, and how many of the words should go in
3325 registers.
3326
3327 @code{FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
3328 register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
3329 @code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
3330
3331 @findex FUNCTION_ARG_PASS_BY_REFERENCE
3332 @item FUNCTION_ARG_PASS_BY_REFERENCE (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3333 A C expression that indicates when an argument must be passed by reference.
3334 If nonzero for an argument, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
3335 pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
3336 The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
3337 to that type.
3338
3339 On machines where @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is not defined, a suitable
3340 definition of this macro might be
3341 @smallexample
3342 #define FUNCTION_ARG_PASS_BY_REFERENCE\
3343 (CUM, MODE, TYPE, NAMED) \
3344 MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (MODE, TYPE)
3345 @end smallexample
3346 @c this is *still* too long. --mew 5feb93
3347
3348 @findex FUNCTION_ARG_CALLEE_COPIES
3349 @item FUNCTION_ARG_CALLEE_COPIES (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3350 If defined, a C expression that indicates when it is the called function's
3351 responsibility to make a copy of arguments passed by invisible reference.
3352 Normally, the caller makes a copy and passes the address of the copy to the
3353 routine being called. When @code{FUNCTION_ARG_CALLEE_COPIES} is defined and is
3354 nonzero, the caller does not make a copy. Instead, it passes a pointer to the
3355 ``live'' value. The called function must not modify this value. If it can be
3356 determined that the value won't be modified, it need not make a copy;
3357 otherwise a copy must be made.
3358
3359 @findex CUMULATIVE_ARGS
3360 @item CUMULATIVE_ARGS
3361 A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument of
3362 @code{FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values. For some target machines,
3363 the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number of bytes of
3364 argument so far.
3365
3366 There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
3367 arguments that have been passed on the stack. The compiler has other
3368 variables to keep track of that. For target machines on which all
3369 arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
3370 @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
3371 should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
3372
3373 @findex INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS
3374 @item INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{indirect})
3375 A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable @var{cum}
3376 for the state at the beginning of the argument list. The variable has
3377 type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. The value of @var{fntype} is the tree node
3378 for the data type of the function which will receive the args, or 0
3379 if the args are to a compiler support library function. The value of
3380 @var{indirect} is nonzero when processing an indirect call, for example
3381 a call through a function pointer. The value of @var{indirect} is zero
3382 for a call to an explicitly named function, a library function call, or when
3383 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
3384 being compiled.
3385
3386 When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
3387 @var{libname} identifies which one. It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
3388 contains the name of the function, as a string. @var{libname} is 0 when
3389 an ordinary C function call is being processed. Thus, each time this
3390 macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
3391 never both of them at once.
3392
3393 @findex INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS
3394 @item INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
3395 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
3396 it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
3397 @code{NULL}. @var{indirect} would always be zero, too. If this macro
3398 is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
3399 0)} is used instead.
3400
3401 @findex INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS
3402 @item INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
3403 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
3404 finding the arguments for the function being compiled. If this macro is
3405 undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
3406
3407 The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
3408 with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@. The
3409 argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
3410 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
3411 @c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
3412 @c --mew 5feb93 i switched the order of the sentences. --mew 10feb93
3413
3414 @findex FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE
3415 @item FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3416 A C statement (sans semicolon) to update the summarizer variable
3417 @var{cum} to advance past an argument in the argument list. The
3418 values @var{mode}, @var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument.
3419 Once this is done, the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing
3420 the @emph{following} argument with @code{FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
3421
3422 This macro need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
3423 on the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
3424 used for arguments without any special help.
3425
3426 @findex FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING
3427 @item FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
3428 If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
3429 to pad out an argument with extra space. The value should be of type
3430 @code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
3431 @code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
3432
3433 The @emph{amount} of padding is always just enough to reach the next
3434 multiple of @code{FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY}; this macro does not control
3435 it.
3436
3437 This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
3438 For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For
3439 big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
3440 constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
3441
3442 @findex PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
3443 @item PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
3444 If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
3445 implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
3446 next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
3447 controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}. If this macro is not defined, all such
3448 arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
3449
3450 @findex FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY
3451 @item FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY (@var{mode}, @var{type})
3452 If defined, a C expression that gives the alignment boundary, in bits,
3453 of an argument with the specified mode and type. If it is not defined,
3454 @code{PARM_BOUNDARY} is used for all arguments.
3455
3456 @findex FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P
3457 @item FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
3458 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
3459 register in which function arguments are sometimes passed. This does
3460 @emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
3461 the structure-value address. On many machines, no registers can be
3462 used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
3463 stack.
3464
3465 @findex LOAD_ARGS_REVERSED
3466 @item LOAD_ARGS_REVERSED
3467 If defined, the order in which arguments are loaded into their
3468 respective argument registers is reversed so that the last
3469 argument is loaded first. This macro only affects arguments
3470 passed in registers.
3471
3472 @end table
3473
3474 @node Scalar Return
3475 @subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
3476 @cindex return values in registers
3477 @cindex values, returned by functions
3478 @cindex scalars, returned as values
3479
3480 This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
3481 values---values that can fit in registers.
3482
3483 @table @code
3484 @findex TRADITIONAL_RETURN_FLOAT
3485 @item TRADITIONAL_RETURN_FLOAT
3486 Define this macro if @option{-traditional} should not cause functions
3487 declared to return @code{float} to convert the value to @code{double}.
3488
3489 @findex FUNCTION_VALUE
3490 @item FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
3491 A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a
3492 function returns a value of data type @var{valtype}. @var{valtype} is
3493 a tree node representing a data type. Write @code{TYPE_MODE
3494 (@var{valtype})} to get the machine mode used to represent that type.
3495 On many machines, only the mode is relevant. (Actually, on most
3496 machines, scalar values are returned in the same place regardless of
3497 mode).
3498
3499 The value of the expression is usually a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3500 register where the return value is stored. The value can also be a
3501 @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in multiple places. See
3502 @code{FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the @code{parallel} form.
3503
3504 If @code{PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} is defined, you must apply the same
3505 promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if @var{valtype} is a
3506 scalar type.
3507
3508 If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
3509 node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
3510 pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
3511 convention for specific functions when all their calls are
3512 known.
3513
3514 @code{FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return vales with aggregate data
3515 types, because these are returned in another way. See
3516 @code{STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM} and related macros, below.
3517
3518 @findex FUNCTION_OUTGOING_VALUE
3519 @item FUNCTION_OUTGOING_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
3520 Define this macro if the target machine has ``register windows''
3521 so that the register in which a function returns its value is not
3522 the same as the one in which the caller sees the value.
3523
3524 For such machines, @code{FUNCTION_VALUE} computes the register in which
3525 the caller will see the value. @code{FUNCTION_OUTGOING_VALUE} should be
3526 defined in a similar fashion to tell the function where to put the
3527 value.
3528
3529 If @code{FUNCTION_OUTGOING_VALUE} is not defined,
3530 @code{FUNCTION_VALUE} serves both purposes.
3531
3532 @code{FUNCTION_OUTGOING_VALUE} is not used for return vales with
3533 aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way. See
3534 @code{STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM} and related macros, below.
3535
3536 @findex LIBCALL_VALUE
3537 @item LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
3538 A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
3539 function returns a value of mode @var{mode}. If the precise function
3540 being called is known, @var{func} is a tree node
3541 (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
3542 pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
3543 convention for specific functions when all their calls are
3544 known.
3545
3546 Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
3547 support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
3548 specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
3549 compiled.
3550
3551 The definition of @code{LIBRARY_VALUE} need not be concerned aggregate
3552 data types, because none of the library functions returns such types.
3553
3554 @findex FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P
3555 @item FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
3556 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
3557 register in which the values of called function may come back.
3558
3559 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
3560 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
3561 recognized by this macro. So for most machines, this definition
3562 suffices:
3563
3564 @example
3565 #define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
3566 @end example
3567
3568 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
3569 function use different registers for the return value, this macro
3570 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
3571
3572 @findex APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
3573 @item APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
3574 Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
3575 need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
3576 saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
3577 @end table
3578
3579 @node Aggregate Return
3580 @subsection How Large Values Are Returned
3581 @cindex aggregates as return values
3582 @cindex large return values
3583 @cindex returning aggregate values
3584 @cindex structure value address
3585
3586 When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
3587 cases), the value is not returned according to @code{FUNCTION_VALUE}
3588 (@pxref{Scalar Return}). Instead, the caller passes the address of a
3589 block of memory in which the value should be stored. This address
3590 is called the @dfn{structure value address}.
3591
3592 This section describes how to control returning structure values in
3593 memory.
3594
3595 @table @code
3596 @findex RETURN_IN_MEMORY
3597 @item RETURN_IN_MEMORY (@var{type})
3598 A C expression which can inhibit the returning of certain function
3599 values in registers, based on the type of value. A nonzero value says
3600 to return the function value in memory, just as large structures are
3601 always returned. Here @var{type} will be a C expression of type
3602 @code{tree}, representing the data type of the value.
3603
3604 Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
3605 by this macro. Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
3606 takes effect regardless of this macro. On most systems, it is
3607 possible to leave the macro undefined; this causes a default
3608 definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
3609 values, and 0 otherwise.
3610
3611 Do not use this macro to indicate that structures and unions should always
3612 be returned in memory. You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
3613 to indicate this.
3614
3615 @findex DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
3616 @item DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
3617 Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
3618 in memory. Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
3619 only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
3620 If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
3621 and union return values are decided by the @code{RETURN_IN_MEMORY} macro.
3622
3623 If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
3624
3625 @findex STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM
3626 @item STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM
3627 If the structure value address is passed in a register, then
3628 @code{STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM} should be the number of that register.
3629
3630 @findex STRUCT_VALUE
3631 @item STRUCT_VALUE
3632 If the structure value address is not passed in a register, define
3633 @code{STRUCT_VALUE} as an expression returning an RTX for the place
3634 where the address is passed. If it returns 0, the address is passed as
3635 an ``invisible'' first argument.
3636
3637 @findex STRUCT_VALUE_INCOMING_REGNUM
3638 @item STRUCT_VALUE_INCOMING_REGNUM
3639 On some architectures the place where the structure value address
3640 is found by the called function is not the same place that the
3641 caller put it. This can be due to register windows, or it could
3642 be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
3643
3644 If the incoming location of the structure value address is in a
3645 register, define this macro as the register number.
3646
3647 @findex STRUCT_VALUE_INCOMING
3648 @item STRUCT_VALUE_INCOMING
3649 If the incoming location is not a register, then you should define
3650 @code{STRUCT_VALUE_INCOMING} as an expression for an RTX for where the
3651 called function should find the value. If it should find the value on
3652 the stack, define this to create a @code{mem} which refers to the frame
3653 pointer. A definition of 0 means that the address is passed as an
3654 ``invisible'' first argument.
3655
3656 @findex PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
3657 @item PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
3658 Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
3659 for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
3660 the address of a static variable containing the value.
3661
3662 Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
3663 pass an address to the subroutine.
3664
3665 This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
3666 nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
3667 @end table
3668
3669 @node Caller Saves
3670 @subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
3671
3672 If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls. This
3673 makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
3674 must live across calls.
3675
3676 @table @code
3677 @findex DEFAULT_CALLER_SAVES
3678 @item DEFAULT_CALLER_SAVES
3679 Define this macro if function calls on the target machine do not preserve
3680 any registers; in other words, if @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} has 1
3681 for all registers. When defined, this macro enables @option{-fcaller-saves}
3682 by default for all optimization levels. It has no effect for optimization
3683 levels 2 and higher, where @option{-fcaller-saves} is the default.
3684
3685 @findex CALLER_SAVE_PROFITABLE
3686 @item CALLER_SAVE_PROFITABLE (@var{refs}, @var{calls})
3687 A C expression to determine whether it is worthwhile to consider placing
3688 a pseudo-register in a call-clobbered hard register and saving and
3689 restoring it around each function call. The expression should be 1 when
3690 this is worth doing, and 0 otherwise.
3691
3692 If you don't define this macro, a default is used which is good on most
3693 machines: @code{4 * @var{calls} < @var{refs}}.
3694
3695 @findex HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE
3696 @item HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
3697 A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
3698 of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}. If
3699 @var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
3700 returned. For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
3701 will select the smallest suitable mode.
3702 @end table
3703
3704 @node Function Entry
3705 @subsection Function Entry and Exit
3706 @cindex function entry and exit
3707 @cindex prologue
3708 @cindex epilogue
3709
3710 This section describes the macros that output function entry
3711 (@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
3712
3713 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
3714 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
3715 function. The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
3716 initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
3717 saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
3718 local variables. @var{size} is an integer. @var{file} is a stdio
3719 stream to which the assembler code should be output.
3720
3721 The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
3722 macro. That has already been done when the macro is run.
3723
3724 @findex regs_ever_live
3725 To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
3726 @code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
3727 @var{r} is used anywhere within the function. This implies the function
3728 prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
3729 call-used registers. (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
3730 @code{regs_ever_live}.)
3731
3732 On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
3733 not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
3734 they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
3735 appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
3736 registers are used in the function.
3737
3738 @findex frame_pointer_needed
3739 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
3740 function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
3741 pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise. To determine whether a
3742 frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
3743 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 at run
3744 time in a function that needs a frame pointer. @xref{Elimination}.
3745
3746 The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
3747 required for the function. This stack space consists of the regions
3748 listed below. In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
3749 order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
3750 stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
3751 the highest address if it is not defined). You can use a different order
3752 for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
3753 compatibility reasons. Except in cases where required by standard
3754 or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
3755 need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
3756 @end deftypefn
3757
3758 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
3759 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
3760 prologue. This should be used when the function prologue is being
3761 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
3762 emitted. @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
3763 @end deftypefn
3764
3765 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
3766 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
3767 epilogue. This should be used when the function epilogue is being
3768 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
3769 emitted. @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
3770 @end deftypefn
3771
3772 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
3773 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
3774 function. The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
3775 registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
3776 called, and returning control to the caller. This macro takes the
3777 same arguments as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
3778 registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
3779 @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
3780
3781 On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
3782 of returning from the function. On these machines, give that
3783 instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
3784 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
3785
3786 Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
3787 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used. If you want the target
3788 switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
3789 define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
3790 target switches appropriately. If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
3791 condition is false, epilogues will be used.
3792
3793 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
3794 function exit code must vary accordingly. Sometimes the code for these
3795 two cases is completely different. To determine whether a frame pointer
3796 is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
3797 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
3798 a function that needs a frame pointer.
3799
3800 Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
3801 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
3802 The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
3803 function. @xref{Leaf Functions}.
3804
3805 On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
3806 others leave that for the caller to do. For example, the 68020 when
3807 given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
3808 number of arguments.
3809
3810 @findex current_function_pops_args
3811 Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
3812 functions pop their own arguments. @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
3813 needs to know what was decided. The variable that is called
3814 @code{current_function_pops_args} is the number of bytes of its
3815 arguments that a function should pop. @xref{Scalar Return}.
3816 @c what is the "its arguments" in the above sentence referring to, pray
3817 @c tell? --mew 5feb93
3818 @end deftypefn
3819
3820 @table @code
3821
3822 @itemize @bullet
3823 @item
3824 @findex current_function_pretend_args_size
3825 A region of @code{current_function_pretend_args_size} bytes of
3826 uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
3827 stack. (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
3828 if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
3829 arguments. But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
3830 yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.) This
3831 region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
3832 registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
3833 features in @code{<varargs.h>} and @code{<stdarg.h>}.
3834
3835 @item
3836 An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
3837 The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
3838 the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
3839 machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
3840 in the function. Machines with register windows often do not require
3841 a save area.
3842
3843 @item
3844 A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
3845 boundary, to contain the local variables of the function. On some machines,
3846 this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
3847 save area closer to the top of the stack.
3848
3849 @item
3850 @cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
3851 Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
3852 @code{current_function_outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
3853 argument lists of the function. @xref{Stack Arguments}.
3854 @end itemize
3855
3856 Normally, it is necessary for the macros
3857 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
3858 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to treat leaf functions specially.
3859 The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
3860 function.
3861
3862 @findex EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
3863 @item EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
3864 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
3865 instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
3866 pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
3867 adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function.
3868
3869 Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
3870 frame pointers are maintained. It is never safe to delete a final
3871 stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
3872 compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
3873
3874 @findex EPILOGUE_USES
3875 @item EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
3876 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
3877 used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern. The stack and frame
3878 pointer registers are already be assumed to be used as needed.
3879
3880 @findex DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE
3881 @item DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE
3882 Define this macro if the function epilogue contains delay slots to which
3883 instructions from the rest of the function can be ``moved''. The
3884 definition should be a C expression whose value is an integer
3885 representing the number of delay slots there.
3886
3887 @findex ELIGIBLE_FOR_EPILOGUE_DELAY
3888 @item ELIGIBLE_FOR_EPILOGUE_DELAY (@var{insn}, @var{n})
3889 A C expression that returns 1 if @var{insn} can be placed in delay
3890 slot number @var{n} of the epilogue.
3891
3892 The argument @var{n} is an integer which identifies the delay slot now
3893 being considered (since different slots may have different rules of
3894 eligibility). It is never negative and is always less than the number
3895 of epilogue delay slots (what @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE} returns).
3896 If you reject a particular insn for a given delay slot, in principle, it
3897 may be reconsidered for a subsequent delay slot. Also, other insns may
3898 (at least in principle) be considered for the so far unfilled delay
3899 slot.
3900
3901 @findex current_function_epilogue_delay_list
3902 @findex final_scan_insn
3903 The insns accepted to fill the epilogue delay slots are put in an RTL
3904 list made with @code{insn_list} objects, stored in the variable
3905 @code{current_function_epilogue_delay_list}. The insn for the first
3906 delay slot comes first in the list. Your definition of the macro
3907 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} should fill the delay slots by
3908 outputting the insns in this list, usually by calling
3909 @code{final_scan_insn}.
3910
3911 You need not define this macro if you did not define
3912 @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE}.
3913
3914 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
3915 @item ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (@var{file}, @var{thunk_fndecl}, @var{delta}, @var{function})
3916 A C compound statement that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
3917 function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
3918 inheritance. The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
3919 adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
3920 the real function.
3921
3922 First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
3923 contains the incoming first argument. Assume that this argument
3924 contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
3925 in C++. This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
3926 e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc. The addition must preserve the values of
3927 all other incoming arguments.
3928
3929 After the addition, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
3930 @code{FUNCTION_DECL}. This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
3931 not touch the return address. Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
3932 return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
3933
3934 The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
3935 the adjusted first argument. This macro is responsible for emitting all
3936 of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
3937 and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
3938
3939 The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant. (@var{delta} and @var{function}
3940 have already been extracted from it.) It might possibly be useful on
3941 some targets, but probably not.
3942
3943 If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
3944 front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
3945 @var{function} instead of jumping to it. The generic approach does
3946 not support varargs.
3947 @end table
3948
3949 @node Profiling
3950 @subsection Generating Code for Profiling
3951 @cindex profiling, code generation
3952
3953 These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
3954
3955 @table @code
3956 @findex FUNCTION_PROFILER
3957 @item FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
3958 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
3959 assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
3960
3961 @findex mcount
3962 The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
3963 your operating system environment, not by GCC@. To figure them out,
3964 compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
3965 compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
3966
3967 Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
3968 variable to be loaded into some register. The name of this variable is
3969 @samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
3970 the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
3971
3972 @findex PROFILE_HOOK
3973 @item PROFILE_HOOK
3974 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
3975 code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
3976 not support profiling.
3977
3978 @findex NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
3979 @item NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
3980 Define this macro if the @code{mcount} subroutine on your system does
3981 not need a counter variable allocated for each function. This is true
3982 for almost all modern implementations. If you define this macro, you
3983 must not use the @var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
3984
3985 @findex PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
3986 @item PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
3987 Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
3988 the function prologue. Normally, the profiling code comes after.
3989
3990 @findex FUNCTION_BLOCK_PROFILER
3991 @vindex profile_block_flag
3992 @item FUNCTION_BLOCK_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
3993 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
3994 assembler code to initialize basic-block profiling for the current
3995 object module. The global compile flag @code{profile_block_flag}
3996 distinguishes two profile modes.
3997
3998 @table @code
3999 @findex __bb_init_func
4000 @item profile_block_flag != 2
4001 Output code to call the subroutine @code{__bb_init_func} once per
4002 object module, passing it as its sole argument the address of a block
4003 allocated in the object module.
4004
4005 The name of the block is a local symbol made with this statement:
4006
4007 @smallexample
4008 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{buffer}, "LPBX", 0);
4009 @end smallexample
4010
4011 Of course, since you are writing the definition of
4012 @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} as well as that of this macro, you
4013 can take a short cut in the definition of this macro and use the name
4014 that you know will result.
4015
4016 The first word of this block is a flag which will be nonzero if the
4017 object module has already been initialized. So test this word first,
4018 and do not call @code{__bb_init_func} if the flag is
4019 nonzero. @var{labelno} contains a unique number which may be used to
4020 generate a label as a branch destination when @code{__bb_init_func}
4021 will not be called.
4022
4023 Described in assembler language, the code to be output looks like:
4024
4025 @example
4026 cmp (LPBX0),0
4027 bne local_label
4028 parameter1 <- LPBX0
4029 call __bb_init_func
4030 local_label:
4031 @end example
4032
4033 @findex __bb_init_trace_func
4034 @item profile_block_flag == 2
4035 Output code to call the subroutine @code{__bb_init_trace_func}
4036 and pass two parameters to it. The first parameter is the same as
4037 for @code{__bb_init_func}. The second parameter is the number of the
4038 first basic block of the function as given by @var{labelno}. Note
4039 that @code{__bb_init_trace_func} has to be called, even if the object
4040 module has been initialized already.
4041
4042 Described in assembler language, the code to be output looks like:
4043 @example
4044 parameter1 <- LPBX0
4045 parameter2 <- @var{labelno}
4046 call __bb_init_trace_func
4047 @end example
4048 @end table
4049
4050 @findex BLOCK_PROFILER
4051 @vindex profile_block_flag
4052 @item BLOCK_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{blockno})
4053 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4054 assembler code to increment the count associated with the basic
4055 block number @var{blockno}. The global compile flag
4056 @code{profile_block_flag} distinguishes two profile modes.
4057
4058 @table @code
4059 @item profile_block_flag != 2
4060 Output code to increment the counter directly. Basic blocks are
4061 numbered separately from zero within each compilation. The count
4062 associated with block number @var{blockno} is at index
4063 @var{blockno} in a vector of words; the name of this array is a local
4064 symbol made with this statement:
4065
4066 @smallexample
4067 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{buffer}, "LPBX", 2);
4068 @end smallexample
4069
4070 @c This paragraph is the same as one a few paragraphs up.
4071 @c That is not an error.
4072 Of course, since you are writing the definition of
4073 @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} as well as that of this macro, you
4074 can take a short cut in the definition of this macro and use the name
4075 that you know will result.
4076
4077 Described in assembler language, the code to be output looks like:
4078
4079 @smallexample
4080 inc (LPBX2+4*@var{blockno})
4081 @end smallexample
4082
4083 @vindex __bb
4084 @findex __bb_trace_func
4085 @item profile_block_flag == 2
4086 Output code to initialize the global structure @code{__bb} and
4087 call the function @code{__bb_trace_func}, which will increment the
4088 counter.
4089
4090 @code{__bb} consists of two words. In the first word, the current
4091 basic block number, as given by @var{blockno}, has to be stored. In
4092 the second word, the address of a block allocated in the object
4093 module has to be stored. The address is given by the label created
4094 with this statement:
4095
4096 @smallexample
4097 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{buffer}, "LPBX", 0);
4098 @end smallexample
4099
4100 Described in assembler language, the code to be output looks like:
4101 @example
4102 move @var{blockno} -> (__bb)
4103 move LPBX0 -> (__bb+4)
4104 call __bb_trace_func
4105 @end example
4106 @end table
4107
4108 @findex FUNCTION_BLOCK_PROFILER_EXIT
4109 @findex __bb_trace_ret
4110 @vindex profile_block_flag
4111 @item FUNCTION_BLOCK_PROFILER_EXIT (@var{file})
4112 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} assembler
4113 code to call function @code{__bb_trace_ret}. The assembler code should
4114 only be output if the global compile flag @code{profile_block_flag} ==
4115 2. This macro has to be used at every place where code for returning
4116 from a function is generated (e.g.@:
4117 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}). Although you have to write the
4118 definition of @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} as well, you have to
4119 define this macro to tell the compiler, that the proper call to
4120 @code{__bb_trace_ret} is produced.
4121
4122 @findex MACHINE_STATE_SAVE
4123 @findex __bb_init_trace_func
4124 @findex __bb_trace_func
4125 @findex __bb_trace_ret
4126 @item MACHINE_STATE_SAVE (@var{id})
4127 A C statement or compound statement to save all registers, which may
4128 be clobbered by a function call, including condition codes. The
4129 @code{asm} statement will be mostly likely needed to handle this
4130 task. Local labels in the assembler code can be concatenated with the
4131 string @var{id}, to obtain a unique label name.
4132
4133 Registers or condition codes clobbered by
4134 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} or
4135 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must be saved in the macros
4136 @code{FUNCTION_BLOCK_PROFILER}, @code{FUNCTION_BLOCK_PROFILER_EXIT} and
4137 @code{BLOCK_PROFILER} prior calling @code{__bb_init_trace_func},
4138 @code{__bb_trace_ret} and @code{__bb_trace_func} respectively.
4139
4140 @findex MACHINE_STATE_RESTORE
4141 @findex __bb_init_trace_func
4142 @findex __bb_trace_func
4143 @findex __bb_trace_ret
4144 @item MACHINE_STATE_RESTORE (@var{id})
4145 A C statement or compound statement to restore all registers, including
4146 condition codes, saved by @code{MACHINE_STATE_SAVE}.
4147
4148 Registers or condition codes clobbered by
4149 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} or
4150 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must be restored in the macros
4151 @code{FUNCTION_BLOCK_PROFILER}, @code{FUNCTION_BLOCK_PROFILER_EXIT} and
4152 @code{BLOCK_PROFILER} after calling @code{__bb_init_trace_func},
4153 @code{__bb_trace_ret} and @code{__bb_trace_func} respectively.
4154
4155 @findex BLOCK_PROFILER_CODE
4156 @item BLOCK_PROFILER_CODE
4157 A C function or functions which are needed in the library to
4158 support block profiling.
4159
4160 @findex TARGET_ALLOWS_PROFILING_WITHOUT_FRAME_POINTER
4161 @item TARGET_ALLOWS_PROFILING_WITHOUT_FRAME_POINTER
4162 On some targets, it is impossible to use profiling when the frame
4163 pointer has been omitted. For example, on x86 GNU/Linux systems,
4164 the @code{mcount} routine provided by the GNU C Library finds the
4165 address of the routine that called the routine that called @code{mcount}
4166 by looking in the immediate caller's stack frame. If the immediate
4167 caller has no frame pointer, this lookup will fail.
4168
4169 By default, GCC assumes that the target does allow profiling when the
4170 frame pointer is omitted. This macro should be defined to a C
4171 expression that evaluates to @code{false} if the target does not allow
4172 profiling when the frame pointer is omitted.
4173
4174 @end table
4175
4176 @node Inlining
4177 @subsection Permitting inlining of functions with attributes
4178 @cindex inlining
4179
4180 By default if a function has a target specific attribute attached to it,
4181 it will not be inlined. This behaviour can be overridden if the target
4182 defines the @samp{FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P} macro. This macro
4183 takes one argument, a @samp{DECL} describing the function. It should
4184 return non-zero if the function can be inlined, otherwise it should
4185 return 0.
4186
4187 @node Tail Calling
4188 @subsection Permitting tail calls to functions
4189 @cindex tail calls
4190 @cindex sibling calls
4191
4192 @table @code
4193 @findex FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL
4194 @item FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL (@var{decl})
4195 A C expression that evaluates to true if it is ok to perform a sibling
4196 call to @var{decl}.
4197
4198 It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4199 tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
4200 during PIC compilation. Use this macro to enforce these restrictions,
4201 as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
4202 ``normal'' call.
4203 @end table
4204
4205 @node Varargs
4206 @section Implementing the Varargs Macros
4207 @cindex varargs implementation
4208
4209 GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
4210 @code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
4211 on the stack. Other machines require their own implementations of
4212 varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
4213 conditionals to include it.
4214
4215 ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
4216 the calling convention for @code{va_start}. The traditional
4217 implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
4218 to store the argument pointer. The ISO implementation of
4219 @code{va_start} takes an additional second argument. The user is
4220 supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
4221
4222 However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument. The way to find
4223 the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
4224 below.
4225
4226 @table @code
4227 @findex __builtin_saveregs
4228 @item __builtin_saveregs ()
4229 Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
4230 that the varargs mechanism can access them. Both ISO and traditional
4231 versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
4232 you use @code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
4233
4234 On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
4235 control of the macro @code{EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. On other machines,
4236 it calls a routine written in assembler language, found in
4237 @file{libgcc2.c}.
4238
4239 Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
4240 beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
4241 @code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
4242 This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
4243 to use them for its own purposes.
4244 @c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
4245 @c 10feb93
4246
4247 @findex __builtin_args_info
4248 @item __builtin_args_info (@var{category})
4249 Use this built-in function to find the first anonymous arguments in
4250 registers.
4251
4252 In general, a machine may have several categories of registers used for
4253 arguments, each for a particular category of data types. (For example,
4254 on some machines, floating-point registers are used for floating-point
4255 arguments while other arguments are passed in the general registers.)
4256 To make non-varargs functions use the proper calling convention, you
4257 have defined the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data type to record how many
4258 registers in each category have been used so far
4259
4260 @code{__builtin_args_info} accesses the same data structure of type
4261 @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} after the ordinary argument layout is finished
4262 with it, with @var{category} specifying which word to access. Thus, the
4263 value indicates the first unused register in a given category.
4264
4265 Normally, you would use @code{__builtin_args_info} in the implementation
4266 of @code{va_start}, accessing each category just once and storing the
4267 value in the @code{va_list} object. This is because @code{va_list} will
4268 have to update the values, and there is no way to alter the
4269 values accessed by @code{__builtin_args_info}.
4270
4271 @findex __builtin_next_arg
4272 @item __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
4273 This is the equivalent of @code{__builtin_args_info}, for stack
4274 arguments. It returns the address of the first anonymous stack
4275 argument, as type @code{void *}. If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
4276 returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
4277 argument. Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
4278 fetching arguments from the stack. Also use it in @code{va_start} to
4279 verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
4280 of the current function.
4281
4282 @findex __builtin_classify_type
4283 @item __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
4284 Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
4285 passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
4286 has to embody these conventions. The easiest way to categorize the
4287 specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
4288 with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
4289
4290 @code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
4291 considering only its data type. It returns an integer describing what
4292 kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
4293
4294 The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
4295 interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
4296 @end table
4297
4298 These machine description macros help implement varargs:
4299
4300 @table @code
4301 @findex EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS
4302 @item EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS ()
4303 If defined, is a C expression that produces the machine-specific code
4304 for a call to @code{__builtin_saveregs}. This code will be moved to the
4305 very beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made.
4306 The return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the
4307 value to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
4308
4309 @findex SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS
4310 @item SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS (@var{args_so_far}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{pretend_args_size}, @var{second_time})
4311 This macro offers an alternative to using @code{__builtin_saveregs} and
4312 defining the macro @code{EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. Use it to store the
4313 anonymous register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments
4314 appear to have been passed consecutively on the stack. Once this is
4315 done, you can use the standard implementation of varargs that works for
4316 machines that pass all their arguments on the stack.
4317
4318 The argument @var{args_so_far} is the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
4319 structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
4320 named arguments. The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
4321 last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
4322
4323 The macro implementation should do two things: first, push onto the
4324 stack all the argument registers @emph{not} used for the named
4325 arguments, and second, store the size of the data thus pushed into the
4326 @code{int}-valued variable whose name is supplied as the argument
4327 @var{pretend_args_size}. The value that you store here will serve as
4328 additional offset for setting up the stack frame.
4329
4330 Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
4331 compile time without knowing their data types,
4332 @code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that have just
4333 a single category of argument register and use it uniformly for all data
4334 types.
4335
4336 If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
4337 arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time. This
4338 happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
4339 end of the source file. The macro @code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
4340 not generate any instructions in this case.
4341
4342 @findex STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING
4343 @item STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING
4344 Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the location where a function
4345 argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
4346
4347 This macro controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
4348 is set for varargs and stdarg functions. If this macro returns a
4349 nonzero value, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
4350 arguments, and false for unnamed arguments. If it returns a value of
4351 zero, but @code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is defined, then all arguments
4352 are treated as named. Otherwise, all named arguments except the last
4353 are treated as named.
4354
4355 You need not define this macro if it always returns zero.
4356
4357 @findex PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED
4358 @item PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED
4359 If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
4360 @code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
4361 @code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
4362 defined, then define this macro to return nonzero if
4363 @code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, zero otherwise.
4364 Otherwise, you should not define this macro.
4365 @end table
4366
4367 @node Trampolines
4368 @section Trampolines for Nested Functions
4369 @cindex trampolines for nested functions
4370 @cindex nested functions, trampolines for
4371
4372 A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
4373 when the address of a nested function is taken. It normally resides on
4374 the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function. These macros
4375 tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
4376 trampoline.
4377
4378 The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
4379 address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
4380 the nested function. On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
4381 two instructions, a move immediate and a jump. Then the two addresses
4382 exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands. On RISC
4383 machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
4384 two parts. Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
4385 operands.
4386
4387 The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
4388 parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
4389 immediate operands of the instructions. On a CISC machine, this is
4390 simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
4391 proper offset from the start of the trampoline. On a RISC machine, it
4392 may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
4393 separately.
4394
4395 @table @code
4396 @findex TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE
4397 @item TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE (@var{file})
4398 A C statement to output, on the stream @var{file}, assembler code for a
4399 block of data that contains the constant parts of a trampoline. This
4400 code should not include a label---the label is taken care of
4401 automatically.
4402
4403 If you do not define this macro, it means no template is needed
4404 for the target. Do not define this macro on systems where the block move
4405 code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
4406 to generate it on the spot.
4407
4408 @findex TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
4409 @item TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
4410 The name of a subroutine to switch to the section in which the
4411 trampoline template is to be placed (@pxref{Sections}). The default is
4412 a value of @samp{readonly_data_section}, which places the trampoline in
4413 the section containing read-only data.
4414
4415 @findex TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
4416 @item TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
4417 A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
4418
4419 @findex TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
4420 @item TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
4421 Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
4422
4423 If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
4424 is used for aligning trampolines.
4425
4426 @findex INITIALIZE_TRAMPOLINE
4427 @item INITIALIZE_TRAMPOLINE (@var{addr}, @var{fnaddr}, @var{static_chain})
4428 A C statement to initialize the variable parts of a trampoline.
4429 @var{addr} is an RTX for the address of the trampoline; @var{fnaddr} is
4430 an RTX for the address of the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
4431 RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
4432 when it is called.
4433
4434 @findex TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS
4435 @item TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS (@var{addr})
4436 A C statement that should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
4437 the address of the trampoline. Its argument contains the address that
4438 was passed to @code{INITIALIZE_TRAMPOLINE}. In case the address to be
4439 used for a function call should be different from the address in which
4440 the template was stored, the different address should be assigned to
4441 @var{addr}. If this macro is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for
4442 function calls.
4443
4444 @findex ALLOCATE_TRAMPOLINE
4445 @item ALLOCATE_TRAMPOLINE (@var{fp})
4446 A C expression to allocate run-time space for a trampoline. The
4447 expression value should be an RTX representing a memory reference to the
4448 space for the trampoline.
4449
4450 @cindex @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} and trampolines
4451 @cindex @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and trampolines
4452 If this macro is not defined, by default the trampoline is allocated as
4453 a stack slot. This default is right for most machines. The exceptions
4454 are machines where it is impossible to execute instructions in the stack
4455 area. On such machines, you may have to implement a separate stack,
4456 using this macro in conjunction with @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4457 and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}.
4458
4459 @var{fp} points to a data structure, a @code{struct function}, which
4460 describes the compilation status of the immediate containing function of
4461 the function which the trampoline is for. Normally (when
4462 @code{ALLOCATE_TRAMPOLINE} is not defined), the stack slot for the
4463 trampoline is in the stack frame of this containing function. Other
4464 allocation strategies probably must do something analogous with this
4465 information.
4466 @end table
4467
4468 Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
4469 separate instruction and data caches. Writing into a stack location
4470 fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
4471 jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
4472
4473 Here are two possible solutions. One is to clear the relevant parts of
4474 the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up. The other is to
4475 make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
4476 subroutine. The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
4477 latter makes initialization faster.
4478
4479 To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
4480 the following macros which describe the shape of the cache.
4481
4482 @table @code
4483 @findex INSN_CACHE_SIZE
4484 @item INSN_CACHE_SIZE
4485 The total size in bytes of the cache.
4486
4487 @findex INSN_CACHE_LINE_WIDTH
4488 @item INSN_CACHE_LINE_WIDTH
4489 The length in bytes of each cache line. The cache is divided into cache
4490 lines which are disjoint slots, each holding a contiguous chunk of data
4491 fetched from memory. Each time data is brought into the cache, an
4492 entire line is read at once. The data loaded into a cache line is
4493 always aligned on a boundary equal to the line size.
4494
4495 @findex INSN_CACHE_DEPTH
4496 @item INSN_CACHE_DEPTH
4497 The number of alternative cache lines that can hold any particular memory
4498 location.
4499 @end table
4500
4501 Alternatively, if the machine has system calls or instructions to clear
4502 the instruction cache directly, you can define the following macro.
4503
4504 @table @code
4505 @findex CLEAR_INSN_CACHE
4506 @item CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
4507 If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
4508 cache} in the specified interval. If it is not defined, and the macro
4509 @code{INSN_CACHE_SIZE} is defined, some generic code is generated to clear the
4510 cache. The definition of this macro would typically be a series of
4511 @code{asm} statements. Both @var{beg} and @var{end} are both pointer
4512 expressions.
4513 @end table
4514
4515 To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro. In addition,
4516 you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
4517 cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
4518 beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
4519 its cache line. Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
4520
4521 @table @code
4522 @findex TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
4523 @item TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
4524 Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
4525 work. The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
4526 which will be compiled with GCC@. They go in a library function named
4527 @code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
4528
4529 If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
4530 C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
4531 special label of your own in the assembler code. Use one @code{asm}
4532 statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
4533 global. Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
4534 special assembler code.
4535 @end table
4536
4537 @node Library Calls
4538 @section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
4539 @cindex library subroutine names
4540 @cindex @file{libgcc.a}
4541
4542 @c prevent bad page break with this line
4543 Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
4544
4545 @table @code
4546 @findex MULSI3_LIBCALL
4547 @item MULSI3_LIBCALL
4548 A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
4549 multiplication of one signed full-word by another. If you do not
4550 define this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__mulsi3},
4551 a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4552
4553 @findex DIVSI3_LIBCALL
4554 @item DIVSI3_LIBCALL
4555 A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
4556 division of one signed full-word by another. If you do not define
4557 this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__divsi3}, a
4558 function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4559
4560 @findex UDIVSI3_LIBCALL
4561 @item UDIVSI3_LIBCALL
4562 A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
4563 division of one unsigned full-word by another. If you do not define
4564 this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__udivsi3}, a
4565 function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4566
4567 @findex MODSI3_LIBCALL
4568 @item MODSI3_LIBCALL
4569 A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for the
4570 remainder in division of one signed full-word by another. If you do
4571 not define this macro, the default name is used, which is
4572 @code{__modsi3}, a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4573
4574 @findex UMODSI3_LIBCALL
4575 @item UMODSI3_LIBCALL
4576 A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for the
4577 remainder in division of one unsigned full-word by another. If you do
4578 not define this macro, the default name is used, which is
4579 @code{__umodsi3}, a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4580
4581 @findex MULDI3_LIBCALL
4582 @item MULDI3_LIBCALL
4583 A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
4584 multiplication of one signed double-word by another. If you do not
4585 define this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__muldi3},
4586 a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4587
4588 @findex DIVDI3_LIBCALL
4589 @item DIVDI3_LIBCALL
4590 A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
4591 division of one signed double-word by another. If you do not define
4592 this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__divdi3}, a
4593 function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4594
4595 @findex UDIVDI3_LIBCALL
4596 @item UDIVDI3_LIBCALL
4597 A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
4598 division of one unsigned full-word by another. If you do not define
4599 this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__udivdi3}, a
4600 function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4601
4602 @findex MODDI3_LIBCALL
4603 @item MODDI3_LIBCALL
4604 A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for the
4605 remainder in division of one signed double-word by another. If you do
4606 not define this macro, the default name is used, which is
4607 @code{__moddi3}, a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4608
4609 @findex UMODDI3_LIBCALL
4610 @item UMODDI3_LIBCALL
4611 A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for the
4612 remainder in division of one unsigned full-word by another. If you do
4613 not define this macro, the default name is used, which is
4614 @code{__umoddi3}, a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4615
4616 @findex INIT_TARGET_OPTABS
4617 @item INIT_TARGET_OPTABS
4618 Define this macro as a C statement that declares additional library
4619 routines renames existing ones. @code{init_optabs} calls this macro after
4620 initializing all the normal library routines.
4621
4622 @findex FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
4623 @item FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL
4624 Define this macro as a C statement that returns nonzero if a call to
4625 the floating point comparison library function will return a boolean
4626 value that indicates the result of the comparison. It should return
4627 zero if one of gcc's own libgcc functions is called.
4628
4629 Most ports don't need to define this macro.
4630
4631 @findex TARGET_EDOM
4632 @cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
4633 @item TARGET_EDOM
4634 The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
4635 expression. If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
4636 deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly. Look in
4637 @file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
4638 system.
4639
4640 If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
4641 domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
4642 error. If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
4643 there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
4644 that @code{matherr} is used normally.
4645
4646 @findex GEN_ERRNO_RTX
4647 @cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
4648 @item GEN_ERRNO_RTX
4649 Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
4650 refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}. (On certain systems,
4651 @code{errno} may not actually be a variable.) If you don't define this
4652 macro, a reasonable default is used.
4653
4654 @findex TARGET_MEM_FUNCTIONS
4655 @cindex @code{bcopy}, implicit usage
4656 @cindex @code{memcpy}, implicit usage
4657 @cindex @code{memmove}, implicit usage
4658 @cindex @code{bzero}, implicit usage
4659 @cindex @code{memset}, implicit usage
4660 @item TARGET_MEM_FUNCTIONS
4661 Define this macro if GCC should generate calls to the ISO C
4662 (and System V) library functions @code{memcpy}, @code{memmove} and
4663 @code{memset} rather than the BSD functions @code{bcopy} and @code{bzero}.
4664
4665 @findex LIBGCC_NEEDS_DOUBLE
4666 @item LIBGCC_NEEDS_DOUBLE
4667 Define this macro if @code{float} arguments cannot be passed to library
4668 routines (so they must be converted to @code{double}). This macro
4669 affects both how library calls are generated and how the library
4670 routines in @file{libgcc.a} accept their arguments. It is useful on
4671 machines where floating and fixed point arguments are passed
4672 differently, such as the i860.
4673
4674 @findex NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
4675 @item NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
4676 Define this macro to generate code for Objective-C message sending using
4677 the calling convention of the NeXT system. This calling convention
4678 involves passing the object, the selector and the method arguments all
4679 at once to the method-lookup library function.
4680
4681 The default calling convention passes just the object and the selector
4682 to the lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
4683 @end table
4684
4685 @node Addressing Modes
4686 @section Addressing Modes
4687 @cindex addressing modes
4688
4689 @c prevent bad page break with this line
4690 This is about addressing modes.
4691
4692 @table @code
4693 @findex HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
4694 @findex HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
4695 @findex HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
4696 @findex HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
4697 @item HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
4698 @itemx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
4699 @itemx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
4700 @itemx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
4701 A C expression that is non-zero if the machine supports pre-increment,
4702 pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
4703
4704 @findex HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
4705 @findex HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
4706 @item HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
4707 @itemx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
4708 A C expression that is non-zero if the machine supports pre- or
4709 post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
4710 the size of the memory operand.
4711
4712 @findex HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
4713 @findex HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
4714 @item HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
4715 @itemx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
4716 A C expression that is non-zero if the machine supports pre- or
4717 post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
4718
4719 @findex CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P
4720 @item CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
4721 A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
4722 is a valid address. On most machines, this can be defined as
4723 @code{CONSTANT_P (@var{x})}, but a few machines are more restrictive
4724 in which constant addresses are supported.
4725
4726 @findex CONSTANT_P
4727 @code{CONSTANT_P} accepts integer-values expressions whose values are
4728 not explicitly known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and
4729 @code{high} expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in
4730 addition to @code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
4731
4732 @findex MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
4733 @item MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
4734 A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
4735 memory address. Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
4736 the maximum number that @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} would ever
4737 accept.
4738
4739 @findex GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS
4740 @item GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
4741 A C compound statement with a conditional @code{goto @var{label};}
4742 executed if @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory address on the
4743 target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
4744
4745 It usually pays to define several simpler macros to serve as
4746 subroutines for this one. Otherwise it may be too complicated to
4747 understand.
4748
4749 This macro must exist in two variants: a strict variant and a
4750 non-strict one. The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It
4751 must be defined so that any pseudo-register that has not been
4752 allocated a hard register is considered a memory reference. In
4753 contexts where some kind of register is required, a pseudo-register
4754 with no hard register must be rejected.
4755
4756 The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
4757 accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
4758 register is required.
4759
4760 @findex REG_OK_STRICT
4761 Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this
4762 macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}. You should use an
4763 @code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant
4764 in that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
4765
4766 Subroutines to check for acceptable registers for various purposes (one
4767 for base registers, one for index registers, and so on) are typically
4768 among the subroutines used to define @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}.
4769 Then only these subroutine macros need have two variants; the higher
4770 levels of macros may be the same whether strict or not.
4771
4772 Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
4773 and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
4774 constant. Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
4775 specifically as legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply
4776 recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
4777
4778 Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
4779 sums that are not marked with @code{const}. It assumes that a naked
4780 @code{plus} indicates indexing. If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
4781 naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
4782 be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
4783
4784 @cindex @code{ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
4785 On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
4786 the section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the
4787 macro @code{ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
4788 @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. When you see a
4789 @code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
4790 @code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section. @xref{Assembler
4791 Format}.
4792
4793 @findex saveable_obstack
4794 The best way to modify the name string is by adding text to the
4795 beginning, with suitable punctuation to prevent any ambiguity. Allocate
4796 the new name in @code{saveable_obstack}. You will have to modify
4797 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to remove and decode the added text and
4798 output the name accordingly, and define @code{STRIP_NAME_ENCODING} to
4799 access the original name string.
4800
4801 You can check the information stored here into the @code{symbol_ref} in
4802 the definitions of the macros @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} and
4803 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
4804
4805 @findex REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P
4806 @item REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{x})
4807 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} (assumed to be a @code{reg}
4808 RTX) is valid for use as a base register. For hard registers, it
4809 should always accept those which the hardware permits and reject the
4810 others. Whether the macro accepts or rejects pseudo registers must be
4811 controlled by @code{REG_OK_STRICT} as described above. This usually
4812 requires two variant definitions, of which @code{REG_OK_STRICT}
4813 controls the one actually used.
4814
4815 @findex REG_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P
4816 @item REG_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{x}, @var{mode})
4817 A C expression that is just like @code{REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
4818 that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
4819 @var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
4820 reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
4821 you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
4822 @code{REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
4823
4824 @findex REG_OK_FOR_INDEX_P
4825 @item REG_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{x})
4826 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} (assumed to be a @code{reg}
4827 RTX) is valid for use as an index register.
4828
4829 The difference between an index register and a base register is that
4830 the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
4831 two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
4832 labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
4833 labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
4834 may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
4835 looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
4836 only if neither labeling works.
4837
4838 @findex FIND_BASE_TERM
4839 @item FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
4840 A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x}.
4841 This macro is used in only one place: `find_base_term' in alias.c.
4842
4843 It is always safe for this macro to not be defined. It exists so
4844 that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
4845
4846 The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
4847 a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
4848
4849 @findex LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
4850 @item LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{oldx}, @var{mode}, @var{win})
4851 A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x} with a valid
4852 memory address for an operand of mode @var{mode}. @var{win} will be a
4853 C statement label elsewhere in the code; the macro definition may use
4854
4855 @example
4856 GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{win});
4857 @end example
4858
4859 @noindent
4860 to avoid further processing if the address has become legitimate.
4861
4862 @findex break_out_memory_refs
4863 @var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
4864 and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
4865 @var{x}.
4866
4867 The code generated by this macro should not alter the substructure of
4868 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
4869 should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
4870
4871 It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
4872 address. The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases. In
4873 fact, it is safe for this macro to do nothing. But often a
4874 machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
4875
4876 @findex LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS
4877 @item LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
4878 A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
4879 that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
4880 @var{mode}. @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
4881 It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
4882 performance reasons.
4883
4884 For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
4885 reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
4886 registers into a register. On the other hand, for number of RISC
4887 processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
4888 needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot. By defining
4889 @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
4890 generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
4891 be shared.
4892
4893 @emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution. It is necessary
4894 to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
4895 and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
4896 of reload internals.
4897
4898 @emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
4899 previous invocation of this macro. If it fails to handle such addresses
4900 then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
4901
4902 @findex push_reload
4903 The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
4904 need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
4905 suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
4906
4907 The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
4908 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
4909 should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
4910 This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
4911 @code{push_reload}.
4912
4913 @findex strict_memory_address_p
4914 The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
4915 the address has become legitimate.
4916
4917 @findex copy_rtx
4918 If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
4919 this is to use @code{copy_rtx}. Note, however, that is unshares only a
4920 single level of rtl. Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
4921 top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
4922 It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
4923 address; but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
4924
4925 @findex GO_IF_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS
4926 @item GO_IF_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS (@var{addr}, @var{label})
4927 A C statement or compound statement with a conditional @code{goto
4928 @var{label};} executed if memory address @var{x} (an RTX) can have
4929 different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
4930 reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
4931 but not others.
4932
4933 Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
4934 effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
4935 of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
4936 addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
4937
4938 You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
4939
4940 @findex LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P
4941 @item LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
4942 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for
4943 an immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that
4944 @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this. In fact,
4945 @samp{1} is a suitable definition for this macro on machines where
4946 anything @code{CONSTANT_P} is valid.
4947 @end table
4948
4949 @node Condition Code
4950 @section Condition Code Status
4951 @cindex condition code status
4952
4953 @c prevent bad page break with this line
4954 This describes the condition code status.
4955
4956 @findex cc_status
4957 The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
4958 describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
4959 the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by). This
4960 variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
4961 currently based, and several standard flags.
4962
4963 Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
4964 description header file. It can also add additional machine-specific
4965 information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
4966
4967 @table @code
4968 @findex CC_STATUS_MDEP
4969 @item CC_STATUS_MDEP
4970 C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
4971 component of @code{cc_status}. It defaults to @code{int}.
4972
4973 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
4974
4975 @findex CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
4976 @item CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
4977 A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
4978 The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
4979 the field anyway. If you want to use the field, you should probably
4980 define this macro to initialize it.
4981
4982 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
4983
4984 @findex NOTICE_UPDATE_CC
4985 @item NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
4986 A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
4987 appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}. It is
4988 this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
4989 code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
4990 set @code{(cc0)}.
4991
4992 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
4993
4994 If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
4995 other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
4996 invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
4997 reflecting. For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
4998 registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
4999 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
5000 insns. But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
5001 based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
5002 value in @samp{a4}. Although the condition code is not changed by
5003 this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
5004 @samp{a4@@(102)}. Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
5005 @code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
5006 condition code value.
5007
5008 The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
5009 with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
5010 @code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
5011 constants which are just the operands. The RTL structure of these
5012 insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do. What
5013 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
5014 @code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
5015
5016 A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
5017 that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
5018 @samp{cc}. This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
5019 two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
5020
5021 @findex EXTRA_CC_MODES
5022 @item EXTRA_CC_MODES
5023 A list of additional modes for condition code values in registers
5024 (@pxref{Jump Patterns}). This macro should expand to a sequence of
5025 calls of the macro @code{CC} separated by white space. @code{CC} takes
5026 two arguments. The first is the enumeration name of the mode, which
5027 should begin with @samp{CC} and end with @samp{mode}. The second is a C
5028 string giving the printable name of the mode; it should be the same as
5029 the first argument, but with the trailing @samp{mode} removed.
5030
5031 You should only define this macro if additional modes are required.
5032
5033 A sample definition of @code{EXTRA_CC_MODES} is:
5034 @smallexample
5035 #define EXTRA_CC_MODES \
5036 CC(CC_NOOVmode, "CC_NOOV") \
5037 CC(CCFPmode, "CCFP") \
5038 CC(CCFPEmode, "CCFPE")
5039 @end smallexample
5040
5041 @findex SELECT_CC_MODE
5042 @item SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
5043 Returns a mode from class @code{MODE_CC} to be used when comparison
5044 operation code @var{op} is applied to rtx @var{x} and @var{y}. For
5045 example, on the Sparc, @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} is defined as (see
5046 @pxref{Jump Patterns} for a description of the reason for this
5047 definition)
5048
5049 @smallexample
5050 #define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
5051 (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT \
5052 ? ((OP == EQ || OP == NE) ? CCFPmode : CCFPEmode) \
5053 : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS \
5054 || GET_CODE (X) == NEG) \
5055 ? CC_NOOVmode : CCmode))
5056 @end smallexample
5057
5058 You need not define this macro if @code{EXTRA_CC_MODES} is not defined.
5059
5060 @findex CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON
5061 @item CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (@var{code}, @var{op0}, @var{op1})
5062 On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
5063 convert an invalid comparison into a valid one. For example, the Alpha
5064 does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
5065 comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
5066
5067 On such machines, define this macro to be a C statement to do any
5068 required conversions. @var{code} is the initial comparison code
5069 and @var{op0} and @var{op1} are the left and right operands of the
5070 comparison, respectively. You should modify @var{code}, @var{op0}, and
5071 @var{op1} as required.
5072
5073 GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
5074 valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
5075 @file{md} file.
5076
5077 You need not define this macro if it would never change the comparison
5078 code or operands.
5079
5080 @findex REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE
5081 @item REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
5082 A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
5083 comparison whose mode is @var{mode}. If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
5084 can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
5085 then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
5086
5087 You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
5088 floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
5089 For example, here is the definition used on the Sparc, where floating-point
5090 inequality comparisons are always given @code{CCFPEmode}:
5091
5092 @smallexample
5093 #define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) ((MODE) != CCFPEmode)
5094 @end smallexample
5095
5096 @findex REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
5097 A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
5098 comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}. The macro is used only in case
5099 @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero. Define this macro in case
5100 machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals. For
5101 instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
5102 freely convert unordered compares to ordered one. Then definition may look
5103 like:
5104
5105 @smallexample
5106 #define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
5107 ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
5108 : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
5109 @end smallexample
5110
5111 @findex REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P
5112 @item REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (@var{code1}, @var{code2})
5113 A C expression that returns true if the conditional execution predicate
5114 @var{code1} is the inverse of @var{code2} and vice versa. Define this to
5115 return 0 if the target has conditional execution predicates that cannot be
5116 reversed safely. If no expansion is specified, this macro is defined as
5117 follows:
5118
5119 @smallexample
5120 #define REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (x, y) \
5121 ((x) == reverse_condition (y))
5122 @end smallexample
5123
5124 @end table
5125
5126 @node Costs
5127 @section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
5128 @cindex costs of instructions
5129 @cindex relative costs
5130 @cindex speed of instructions
5131
5132 These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
5133 on the target machine.
5134
5135 @table @code
5136 @findex CONST_COSTS
5137 @item CONST_COSTS (@var{x}, @var{code}, @var{outer_code})
5138 A part of a C @code{switch} statement that describes the relative costs
5139 of constant RTL expressions. It must contain @code{case} labels for
5140 expression codes @code{const_int}, @code{const}, @code{symbol_ref},
5141 @code{label_ref} and @code{const_double}. Each case must ultimately
5142 reach a @code{return} statement to return the relative cost of the use
5143 of that kind of constant value in an expression. The cost may depend on
5144 the precise value of the constant, which is available for examination in
5145 @var{x}, and the rtx code of the expression in which it is contained,
5146 found in @var{outer_code}.
5147
5148 @var{code} is the expression code---redundant, since it can be
5149 obtained with @code{GET_CODE (@var{x})}.
5150
5151 @findex RTX_COSTS
5152 @findex COSTS_N_INSNS
5153 @item RTX_COSTS (@var{x}, @var{code}, @var{outer_code})
5154 Like @code{CONST_COSTS} but applies to nonconstant RTL expressions.
5155 This can be used, for example, to indicate how costly a multiply
5156 instruction is. In writing this macro, you can use the construct
5157 @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
5158 instructions. @var{outer_code} is the code of the expression in which
5159 @var{x} is contained.
5160
5161 This macro is optional; do not define it if the default cost assumptions
5162 are adequate for the target machine.
5163
5164 @findex DEFAULT_RTX_COSTS
5165 @item DEFAULT_RTX_COSTS (@var{x}, @var{code}, @var{outer_code})
5166 This macro, if defined, is called for any case not handled by the
5167 @code{RTX_COSTS} or @code{CONST_COSTS} macros. This eliminates the need
5168 to put case labels into the macro, but the code, or any functions it
5169 calls, must assume that the RTL in @var{x} could be of any type that has
5170 not already been handled. The arguments are the same as for
5171 @code{RTX_COSTS}, and the macro should execute a return statement giving
5172 the cost of any RTL expressions that it can handle. The default cost
5173 calculation is used for any RTL for which this macro does not return a
5174 value.
5175
5176 This macro is optional; do not define it if the default cost assumptions
5177 are adequate for the target machine.
5178
5179 @findex ADDRESS_COST
5180 @item ADDRESS_COST (@var{address})
5181 An expression giving the cost of an addressing mode that contains
5182 @var{address}. If not defined, the cost is computed from
5183 the @var{address} expression and the @code{CONST_COSTS} values.
5184
5185 For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
5186 true cost of the addressing mode. However, on RISC machines, all
5187 instructions normally have the same length and execution time. Hence
5188 all addresses will have equal costs.
5189
5190 In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
5191 the lowest cost will be used. If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
5192 cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
5193
5194 For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
5195 and a constant is used twice in the same basic block. When this macro
5196 is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
5197 references will be indirect through that register. On machines where
5198 the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
5199 that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
5200 instruction and possibly require an additional register. Proper
5201 specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
5202
5203 Similar use of this macro is made in strength reduction of loops.
5204
5205 @var{address} need not be valid as an address. In such a case, the cost
5206 is not relevant and can be any value; invalid addresses need not be
5207 assigned a different cost.
5208
5209 On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
5210 cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
5211 @code{ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to be live
5212 over a region of code where only one would have been if
5213 @code{ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner. This effect should
5214 be considered in the definition of this macro. Equivalent costs should
5215 probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of registers
5216 on machines with lots of registers.
5217
5218 This macro will normally either not be defined or be defined as a
5219 constant.
5220
5221 @findex REGISTER_MOVE_COST
5222 @item REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
5223 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
5224 register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes are
5225 expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. A
5226 value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
5227 that.
5228
5229 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
5230 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
5231 registers if they are not general registers.
5232
5233 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
5234 hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
5235 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
5236 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
5237 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
5238 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
5239
5240 @findex MEMORY_MOVE_COST
5241 @item MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
5242 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
5243 register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
5244 is to be written to memory, non-zero if it is to be read in. This cost
5245 is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. If moving between
5246 registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
5247 should define this macro to express the relative cost.
5248
5249 If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
5250 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
5251 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
5252 between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
5253 more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
5254 reflect the actual cost of the move.
5255
5256 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
5257 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
5258 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
5259 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
5260 4 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
5261 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
5262 are the same as to this macro.
5263
5264 @findex BRANCH_COST
5265 @item BRANCH_COST
5266 A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction. A value of 1 is
5267 the default; other values are interpreted relative to that.
5268 @end table
5269
5270 Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
5271 but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
5272 ordinarily expect.
5273
5274 @table @code
5275 @findex SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
5276 @item SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
5277 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
5278 than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
5279 faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
5280 require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
5281 between byte and (aligned) word loads.
5282
5283 When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
5284 finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
5285 load will be used if alignment permits. Unless bytes accesses are
5286 faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
5287 may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
5288 other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
5289
5290 @findex SLOW_ZERO_EXTEND
5291 @item SLOW_ZERO_EXTEND
5292 Define this macro if zero-extension (of a @code{char} or @code{short}
5293 to an @code{int}) can be done faster if the destination is a register
5294 that is known to be zero.
5295
5296 If you define this macro, you must have instruction patterns that
5297 recognize RTL structures like this:
5298
5299 @smallexample
5300 (set (strict_low_part (subreg:QI (reg:SI @dots{}) 0)) @dots{})
5301 @end smallexample
5302
5303 @noindent
5304 and likewise for @code{HImode}.
5305
5306 @findex SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS
5307 @item SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
5308 Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
5309 @var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
5310 than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
5311 handler.
5312
5313 When this macro is non-zero, the compiler will act as if
5314 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were non-zero when generating code for block
5315 moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
5316 Therefore, do not set this macro non-zero if unaligned accesses only add a
5317 cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
5318
5319 If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined. If
5320 this macro is defined, it should produce a non-zero value when
5321 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is non-zero.
5322
5323 @findex DONT_REDUCE_ADDR
5324 @item DONT_REDUCE_ADDR
5325 Define this macro to inhibit strength reduction of memory addresses.
5326 (On some machines, such strength reduction seems to do harm rather
5327 than good.)
5328
5329 @findex MOVE_RATIO
5330 @item MOVE_RATIO
5331 The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
5332 which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
5333 string move insn or a library call. Increasing the value will always
5334 make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
5335
5336 Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
5337 @code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
5338 the number of such sequences.
5339
5340 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
5341
5342 @findex MOVE_BY_PIECES_P
5343 @item MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
5344 A C expression used to determine whether @code{move_by_pieces} will be used to
5345 copy a chunk of memory, or whether some other block move mechanism
5346 will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
5347 than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
5348
5349 @findex MOVE_MAX_PIECES
5350 @item MOVE_MAX_PIECES
5351 A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
5352 a load or store used to copy memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
5353
5354 @findex USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT
5355 @item USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
5356 A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
5357 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
5358 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
5359
5360 @findex USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT
5361 @item USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
5362 A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
5363 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
5364 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
5365
5366 @findex USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT
5367 @item USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
5368 A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
5369 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
5370 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
5371
5372 @findex USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT
5373 @item USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
5374 A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
5375 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
5376 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
5377
5378 @findex USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT
5379 @item USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
5380 A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
5381 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
5382 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
5383
5384 @findex USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT
5385 @item USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
5386 A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
5387 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
5388 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
5389
5390 @findex USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT
5391 @item USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
5392 This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
5393 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
5394 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
5395
5396 @findex USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT
5397 @item USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
5398 This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
5399 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
5400 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
5401
5402 @findex NO_FUNCTION_CSE
5403 @item NO_FUNCTION_CSE
5404 Define this macro if it is as good or better to call a constant
5405 function address than to call an address kept in a register.
5406
5407 @findex NO_RECURSIVE_FUNCTION_CSE
5408 @item NO_RECURSIVE_FUNCTION_CSE
5409 Define this macro if it is as good or better for a function to call
5410 itself with an explicit address than to call an address kept in a
5411 register.
5412
5413 @findex ADJUST_COST
5414 @item ADJUST_COST (@var{insn}, @var{link}, @var{dep_insn}, @var{cost})
5415 A C statement (sans semicolon) to update the integer variable @var{cost}
5416 based on the relationship between @var{insn} that is dependent on
5417 @var{dep_insn} through the dependence @var{link}. The default is to
5418 make no adjustment to @var{cost}. This can be used for example to
5419 specify to the scheduler that an output- or anti-dependence does not
5420 incur the same cost as a data-dependence.
5421
5422 @findex ADJUST_PRIORITY
5423 @item ADJUST_PRIORITY (@var{insn})
5424 A C statement (sans semicolon) to update the integer scheduling
5425 priority @code{INSN_PRIORITY(@var{insn})}. Reduce the priority
5426 to execute the @var{insn} earlier, increase the priority to execute
5427 @var{insn} later. Do not define this macro if you do not need to
5428 adjust the scheduling priorities of insns.
5429 @end table
5430
5431 @node Sections
5432 @section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
5433 @c the above section title is WAY too long. maybe cut the part between
5434 @c the (...)? --mew 10feb93
5435
5436 An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
5437 data. In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
5438 section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
5439 section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
5440 section}, which holds uninitialized data. Some systems have other kinds
5441 of sections.
5442
5443 The compiler must tell the assembler when to switch sections. These
5444 macros control what commands to output to tell the assembler this. You
5445 can also define additional sections.
5446
5447 @table @code
5448 @findex TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
5449 @item TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
5450 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
5451 assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
5452 Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
5453
5454 @findex DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
5455 @item DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
5456 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
5457 assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
5458 data. Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
5459
5460 @findex SHARED_SECTION_ASM_OP
5461 @item SHARED_SECTION_ASM_OP
5462 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
5463 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
5464 shared data. If not defined, @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP} will be used.
5465
5466 @findex BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
5467 @item BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
5468 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
5469 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
5470 uninitialized global data. If not defined, and neither
5471 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS} nor @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} are defined,
5472 uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
5473 @option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
5474 used.
5475
5476 @findex SHARED_BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
5477 @item SHARED_BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
5478 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
5479 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
5480 uninitialized global shared data. If not defined, and
5481 @code{BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP} is, the latter will be used.
5482
5483 @findex INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
5484 @item INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
5485 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
5486 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
5487 initialization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
5488 not exist.
5489
5490 @findex FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
5491 @item FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
5492 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
5493 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
5494 finalization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
5495 not exist.
5496
5497 @findex CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION
5498 @item CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION
5499 If defined, a C statement that calls the function named as the sole
5500 argument of this macro. This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
5501 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls to
5502 initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
5503 sections. By default, this macro is a simple function call. Some
5504 ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
5505 registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
5506 constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
5507
5508 @findex EXTRA_SECTIONS
5509 @findex in_text
5510 @findex in_data
5511 @item EXTRA_SECTIONS
5512 A list of names for sections other than the standard two, which are
5513 @code{in_text} and @code{in_data}. You need not define this macro
5514 on a system with no other sections (that GCC needs to use).
5515
5516 @findex EXTRA_SECTION_FUNCTIONS
5517 @findex text_section
5518 @findex data_section
5519 @item EXTRA_SECTION_FUNCTIONS
5520 One or more functions to be defined in @file{varasm.c}. These
5521 functions should do jobs analogous to those of @code{text_section} and
5522 @code{data_section}, for your additional sections. Do not define this
5523 macro if you do not define @code{EXTRA_SECTIONS}.
5524
5525 @findex READONLY_DATA_SECTION
5526 @item READONLY_DATA_SECTION
5527 On most machines, read-only variables, constants, and jump tables are
5528 placed in the text section. If this is not the case on your machine,
5529 this macro should be defined to be the name of a function (either
5530 @code{data_section} or a function defined in @code{EXTRA_SECTIONS}) that
5531 switches to the section to be used for read-only items.
5532
5533 If these items should be placed in the text section, this macro should
5534 not be defined.
5535
5536 @findex SELECT_SECTION
5537 @item SELECT_SECTION (@var{exp}, @var{reloc})
5538 A C statement or statements to switch to the appropriate section for
5539 output of @var{exp}. You can assume that @var{exp} is either a
5540 @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of some sort. @var{reloc}
5541 indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time
5542 relocations. Select the section by calling @code{text_section} or one
5543 of the alternatives for other sections.
5544
5545 Do not define this macro if you put all read-only variables and
5546 constants in the read-only data section (usually the text section).
5547
5548 @findex SELECT_RTX_SECTION
5549 @item SELECT_RTX_SECTION (@var{mode}, @var{rtx})
5550 A C statement or statements to switch to the appropriate section for
5551 output of @var{rtx} in mode @var{mode}. You can assume that @var{rtx}
5552 is some kind of constant in RTL@. The argument @var{mode} is redundant
5553 except in the case of a @code{const_int} rtx. Select the section by
5554 calling @code{text_section} or one of the alternatives for other
5555 sections.
5556
5557 Do not define this macro if you put all constants in the read-only
5558 data section.
5559
5560 @findex JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
5561 @item JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
5562 Define this macro to be an expression with a non-zero value if jump
5563 tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
5564 section, along with the assembler instructions. Otherwise, the
5565 readonly data section is used.
5566
5567 This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
5568
5569 @findex ENCODE_SECTION_INFO
5570 @item ENCODE_SECTION_INFO (@var{decl})
5571 Define this macro if references to a symbol must be treated differently
5572 depending on something about the variable or function named by the
5573 symbol (such as what section it is in).
5574
5575 The macro definition, if any, is executed immediately after the rtl for
5576 @var{decl} has been created and stored in @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})}.
5577 The value of the rtl will be a @code{mem} whose address is a
5578 @code{symbol_ref}.
5579
5580 @cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
5581 The usual thing for this macro to do is to record a flag in the
5582 @code{symbol_ref} (such as @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}) or to store a
5583 modified name string in the @code{symbol_ref} (if one bit is not enough
5584 information).
5585
5586 @findex STRIP_NAME_ENCODING
5587 @item STRIP_NAME_ENCODING (@var{var}, @var{sym_name})
5588 Decode @var{sym_name} and store the real name part in @var{var}, sans
5589 the characters that encode section info. Define this macro if
5590 @code{ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} alters the symbol's name string.
5591
5592 @findex UNIQUE_SECTION_P
5593 @item UNIQUE_SECTION_P (@var{decl})
5594 A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{decl} should be placed
5595 into a unique section for some target-specific reason. If you do not
5596 define this macro, the default is @samp{0}. Note that the flag
5597 @option{-ffunction-sections} will also cause functions to be placed into
5598 unique sections.
5599
5600 @findex UNIQUE_SECTION
5601 @item UNIQUE_SECTION (@var{decl}, @var{reloc})
5602 A C statement to build up a unique section name, expressed as a
5603 @code{STRING_CST} node, and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
5604 @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp} requires
5605 link-time relocations. If you do not define this macro, GCC will use
5606 the symbol name prefixed by @samp{.} as the section name. Note - this
5607 macro can now be called for uninitialised data items as well as
5608 initialised data and functions.
5609 @end table
5610
5611 @node PIC
5612 @section Position Independent Code
5613 @cindex position independent code
5614 @cindex PIC
5615
5616 This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
5617 independent code. Simply defining these macros is not enough to
5618 generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the macros
5619 @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} and @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as
5620 well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}. You must modify the definition of
5621 @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate when the source operand
5622 contains a symbolic address. You may also need to alter the handling of
5623 switch statements so that they use relative addresses.
5624 @c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
5625 @c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
5626
5627 @table @code
5628 @findex PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
5629 @item PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
5630 The register number of the register used to address a table of static
5631 data addresses in memory. In some cases this register is defined by a
5632 processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@. When this macro
5633 is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
5634 pointer and frame pointer registers. If this macro is not defined, it
5635 is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
5636 necessary).
5637
5638 @findex PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
5639 @item PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
5640 Define this macro if the register defined by
5641 @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls. Do not define
5642 this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
5643
5644 @findex FINALIZE_PIC
5645 @item FINALIZE_PIC
5646 By generating position-independent code, when two different programs (A
5647 and B) share a common library (libC.a), the text of the library can be
5648 shared whether or not the library is linked at the same address for both
5649 programs. In some of these environments, position-independent code
5650 requires not only the use of different addressing modes, but also
5651 special code to enable the use of these addressing modes.
5652
5653 The @code{FINALIZE_PIC} macro serves as a hook to emit these special
5654 codes once the function is being compiled into assembly code, but not
5655 before. (It is not done before, because in the case of compiling an
5656 inline function, it would lead to multiple PIC prologues being
5657 included in functions which used inline functions and were compiled to
5658 assembly language.)
5659
5660 @findex LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P
5661 @item LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
5662 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
5663 operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
5664 You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
5665 check this. You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
5666 check it either. You need not define this macro if all constants
5667 (including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
5668 position independent code.
5669 @end table
5670
5671 @node Assembler Format
5672 @section Defining the Output Assembler Language
5673
5674 This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
5675 to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
5676 instructions do.
5677
5678 @menu
5679 * File Framework:: Structural information for the assembler file.
5680 * Data Output:: Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
5681 * Uninitialized Data:: Output of uninitialized variables.
5682 * Label Output:: Output and generation of labels.
5683 * Initialization:: General principles of initialization
5684 and termination routines.
5685 * Macros for Initialization::
5686 Specific macros that control the handling of
5687 initialization and termination routines.
5688 * Instruction Output:: Output of actual instructions.
5689 * Dispatch Tables:: Output of jump tables.
5690 * Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
5691 * Alignment Output:: Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
5692 @end menu
5693
5694 @node File Framework
5695 @subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
5696 @cindex assembler format
5697 @cindex output of assembler code
5698
5699 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5700 This describes the overall framework of an assembler file.
5701
5702 @table @code
5703 @findex ASM_FILE_START
5704 @item ASM_FILE_START (@var{stream})
5705 A C expression which outputs to the stdio stream @var{stream}
5706 some appropriate text to go at the start of an assembler file.
5707
5708 Normally this macro is defined to output a line containing
5709 @samp{#NO_APP}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
5710 assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it can save time by not
5711 checking for certain assembler constructs.
5712
5713 On systems that use SDB, it is necessary to output certain commands;
5714 see @file{attasm.h}.
5715
5716 @findex ASM_FILE_END
5717 @item ASM_FILE_END (@var{stream})
5718 A C expression which outputs to the stdio stream @var{stream}
5719 some appropriate text to go at the end of an assembler file.
5720
5721 If this macro is not defined, the default is to output nothing
5722 special at the end of the file. Most systems don't require any
5723 definition.
5724
5725 On systems that use SDB, it is necessary to output certain commands;
5726 see @file{attasm.h}.
5727
5728 @findex ASM_COMMENT_START
5729 @item ASM_COMMENT_START
5730 A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
5731 assembler language. The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
5732 the end of the line.
5733
5734 @findex ASM_APP_ON
5735 @item ASM_APP_ON
5736 A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
5737 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
5738 @code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
5739 assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
5740 that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
5741
5742 @findex ASM_APP_OFF
5743 @item ASM_APP_OFF
5744 A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
5745 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
5746 @code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
5747 time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
5748
5749 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME
5750 @item ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
5751 A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
5752 which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
5753 the stdio stream @var{stream}.
5754
5755 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
5756 for the file format in use is appropriate.
5757
5758 @findex OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING
5759 @item OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
5760 A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
5761 @var{stream}. If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
5762 in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
5763 the assembler source. So you can use it to canonicalize the format
5764 of the filename using this macro.
5765
5766 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE
5767 @item ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
5768 A C statement to output DBX or SDB debugging information before code
5769 for line number @var{line} of the current source file to the
5770 stdio stream @var{stream}.
5771
5772 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of debugging
5773 information for the debugger in use is appropriate.
5774
5775 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT
5776 @item ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (@var{stream}, @var{string})
5777 A C statement to output something to the assembler file to handle a
5778 @samp{#ident} directive containing the text @var{string}. If this
5779 macro is not defined, nothing is output for a @samp{#ident} directive.
5780
5781 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_SECTION_NAME
5782 @item ASM_OUTPUT_SECTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{reloc})
5783 A C statement to output something to the assembler file to switch to section
5784 @var{name} for object @var{decl} which is either a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, a
5785 @code{VAR_DECL} or @code{NULL_TREE}. @var{reloc}
5786 indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time
5787 relocations. The string given by @var{name} will always be the
5788 canonical version stored in the global stringpool.
5789
5790 Some target formats do not support arbitrary sections. Do not define
5791 this macro in such cases.
5792
5793 At present this macro is only used to support section attributes.
5794 When this macro is undefined, section attributes are disabled.
5795
5796 @findex OBJC_PROLOGUE
5797 @item OBJC_PROLOGUE
5798 A C statement to output any assembler statements which are required to
5799 precede any Objective-C object definitions or message sending. The
5800 statement is executed only when compiling an Objective-C program.
5801 @end table
5802
5803 @need 2000
5804 @node Data Output
5805 @subsection Output of Data
5806
5807 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5808 This describes data output.
5809
5810 @table @code
5811 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_LONG_DOUBLE
5812 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE
5813 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_FLOAT
5814 @item ASM_OUTPUT_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{stream}, @var{value})
5815 @itemx ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE (@var{stream}, @var{value})
5816 @itemx ASM_OUTPUT_FLOAT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
5817 @itemx ASM_OUTPUT_THREE_QUARTER_FLOAT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
5818 @itemx ASM_OUTPUT_SHORT_FLOAT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
5819 @itemx ASM_OUTPUT_BYTE_FLOAT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
5820 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
5821 instruction to assemble a floating-point constant of @code{TFmode},
5822 @code{DFmode}, @code{SFmode}, @code{TQFmode}, @code{HFmode}, or
5823 @code{QFmode}, respectively, whose value is @var{value}. @var{value}
5824 will be a C expression of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}. Macros such as
5825 @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE} are useful for writing these
5826 definitions.
5827
5828 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_QUADRUPLE_INT
5829 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE_INT
5830 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_INT
5831 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_SHORT
5832 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_CHAR
5833 @findex output_addr_const
5834 @item ASM_OUTPUT_QUADRUPLE_INT (@var{stream}, @var{exp})
5835 @itemx ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE_INT (@var{stream}, @var{exp})
5836 @itemx ASM_OUTPUT_INT (@var{stream}, @var{exp})
5837 @itemx ASM_OUTPUT_SHORT (@var{stream}, @var{exp})
5838 @itemx ASM_OUTPUT_CHAR (@var{stream}, @var{exp})
5839 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
5840 instruction to assemble an integer of 16, 8, 4, 2 or 1 bytes,
5841 respectively, whose value is @var{value}. The argument @var{exp} will
5842 be an RTL expression which represents a constant value. Use
5843 @samp{output_addr_const (@var{stream}, @var{exp})} to output this value
5844 as an assembler expression.
5845
5846 For sizes larger than @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}, if the action of a macro
5847 would be identical to repeatedly calling the macro corresponding to
5848 a size of @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}, once for each word, you need not define
5849 the macro.
5850
5851 @findex OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA
5852 @item OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{fail})
5853 A C statement to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that
5854 @code{output_addr_const} can't deal with, and output assembly code to
5855 @var{stream} corresponding to the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to
5856 allow machine-dependent @code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
5857
5858 If @code{OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA} fails to recognize a pattern, it must
5859 @code{goto fail}, so that a standard error message is printed. If it
5860 prints an error message itself, by calling, for example,
5861 @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just complete normally.
5862
5863 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_BYTE
5864 @item ASM_OUTPUT_BYTE (@var{stream}, @var{value})
5865 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
5866 instruction to assemble a single byte containing the number @var{value}.
5867
5868 @findex ASM_BYTE_OP
5869 @item ASM_BYTE_OP
5870 A C string constant, including spacing, giving the pseudo-op to use for a
5871 sequence of single-byte constants. If this macro is not defined, the
5872 default is @code{"\t.byte\t"}.
5873
5874 @findex UNALIGNED_SHORT_ASM_OP
5875 @findex UNALIGNED_INT_ASM_OP
5876 @findex UNALIGNED_DOUBLE_INT_ASM_OP
5877 @item UNALIGNED_SHORT_ASM_OP
5878 @itemx UNALIGNED_INT_ASM_OP
5879 @itemx UNALIGNED_DOUBLE_INT_ASM_OP
5880 A C string constant, including spacing, giving the pseudo-op to use
5881 to assemble 16-, 32-, and 64-bit integers respectively @emph{without}
5882 adding implicit padding or alignment. These macros are required if
5883 DWARF 2 frame unwind is used. On ELF systems, these will default
5884 to @code{.2byte}, @code{.4byte}, and @code{.8byte}.
5885
5886 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII
5887 @item ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
5888 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
5889 instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
5890 bytes at @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
5891 @code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
5892
5893 If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
5894 Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
5895 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
5896
5897 @findex CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
5898 @item CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
5899 You may define this macro as a C expression. You should define the
5900 expression to have a non-zero value if GCC should output the constant
5901 pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
5902 GCC should output the constant pool after the function. If you do
5903 not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
5904 pool before the function.
5905
5906 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE
5907 @item ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
5908 A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
5909 constant pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving
5910 the name of the function. Should the return type of the function
5911 be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}. @var{size}
5912 is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
5913 immediately after this call.
5914
5915 If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
5916 not be defined.
5917
5918 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY
5919 @item ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
5920 A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
5921 constant pool, if it needs special treatment. (This macro need not do
5922 anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
5923
5924 The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
5925 assembler code on. @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
5926 output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
5927 @samp{const_int}). @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
5928 @var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
5929 alignment.
5930
5931 The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
5932 the address of this pool entry. The definition of this macro is
5933 responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
5934 Here is how to do this:
5935
5936 @example
5937 ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
5938 @end example
5939
5940 When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
5941 @code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}. This will prevent the same pool
5942 entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
5943
5944 You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
5945
5946 @findex CONSTANT_AFTER_FUNCTION_P
5947 @item CONSTANT_AFTER_FUNCTION_P (@var{exp})
5948 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if the constant
5949 @var{exp}, of type @code{tree}, should be output after the code for a
5950 function. The compiler will normally output all constants before the
5951 function; you need not define this macro if this is OK@.
5952
5953 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE
5954 @item ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
5955 A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
5956 pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
5957 function. Should the return type of the function be required, you can
5958 obtain it via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
5959 constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
5960
5961 If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
5962 define this macro.
5963
5964 @findex IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR
5965 @item IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C})
5966 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
5967 used as a logical line separator by the assembler.
5968
5969 If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
5970 the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
5971 @end table
5972
5973 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
5974 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_CLOSE_PAREN
5975 These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
5976 assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions. If not overridden, they
5977 default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
5978 @end deftypevr
5979
5980 These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
5981 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
5982
5983 @table @code
5984 @item REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
5985 @itemx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
5986 @itemx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
5987 @findex REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE
5988 @findex REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE
5989 @findex REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE
5990 These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the target's
5991 floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in the array of
5992 @code{long int} whose address is @var{l}. The number of elements in the
5993 output array is determined by the size of the desired target floating
5994 point data type: 32 bits of it go in each @code{long int} array
5995 element. Each array element holds 32 bits of the result, even if
5996 @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits on the host machine.
5997
5998 The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
5999 using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
6000 machine's memory.
6001
6002 @item REAL_VALUE_TO_DECIMAL (@var{x}, @var{format}, @var{string})
6003 @findex REAL_VALUE_TO_DECIMAL
6004 This macro converts @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to a
6005 decimal number and stores it as a string into @var{string}.
6006 You must pass, as @var{string}, the address of a long enough block
6007 of space to hold the result.
6008
6009 The argument @var{format} is a @code{printf}-specification that serves
6010 as a suggestion for how to format the output string.
6011 @end table
6012
6013 @node Uninitialized Data
6014 @subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
6015
6016 Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
6017 outputting a single uninitialized variable.
6018
6019 @table @code
6020 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON
6021 @item ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
6022 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6023 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
6024 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
6025 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
6026
6027 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
6028 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
6029 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
6030
6031 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
6032 common global variables are output.
6033
6034 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON
6035 @item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
6036 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
6037 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
6038 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
6039 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
6040 as the number of bits.
6041
6042 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON
6043 @item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
6044 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
6045 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
6046 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
6047 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
6048 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}. Define this macro when you need to see
6049 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
6050
6051 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_COMMON
6052 @item ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
6053 If defined, it is similar to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, except that it
6054 is used when @var{name} is shared. If not defined, @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}
6055 will be used.
6056
6057 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_BSS
6058 @item ASM_OUTPUT_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
6059 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6060 @var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
6061 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
6062 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
6063
6064 Try to use function @code{asm_output_bss} defined in @file{varasm.c} when
6065 defining this macro. If unable, use the expression
6066 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
6067 before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
6068 the name, and a newline.
6069
6070 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized global
6071 variables are output. This macro exists to properly support languages like
6072 C++ which do not have @code{common} data. However, this macro currently
6073 is not defined for all targets. If this macro and
6074 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} are not defined then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}
6075 or @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} or
6076 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON} is used.
6077
6078 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS
6079 @item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
6080 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS} except takes the required alignment as a
6081 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
6082 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS}, and gives you more flexibility in
6083 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
6084 as the number of bits.
6085
6086 Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
6087 @file{varasm.c} when defining this macro.
6088
6089 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_BSS
6090 @item ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
6091 If defined, it is similar to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS}, except that it
6092 is used when @var{name} is shared. If not defined, @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS}
6093 will be used.
6094
6095 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL
6096 @item ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
6097 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6098 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
6099 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
6100 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
6101
6102 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
6103 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
6104 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
6105
6106 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
6107 static variables are output.
6108
6109 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL
6110 @item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
6111 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
6112 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
6113 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
6114 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
6115 as the number of bits.
6116
6117 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL
6118 @item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
6119 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
6120 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
6121 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
6122 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
6123 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}. Define this macro when you need to see
6124 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
6125
6126 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_LOCAL
6127 @item ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
6128 If defined, it is similar to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, except that it
6129 is used when @var{name} is shared. If not defined, @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}
6130 will be used.
6131 @end table
6132
6133 @node Label Output
6134 @subsection Output and Generation of Labels
6135
6136 @c prevent bad page break with this line
6137 This is about outputting labels.
6138
6139 @table @code
6140 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL
6141 @findex assemble_name
6142 @item ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6143 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6144 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
6145 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
6146 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
6147 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
6148
6149 @findex ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME
6150 @item ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
6151 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6152 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
6153 function which is being defined. This macro is responsible for
6154 outputting the label definition (perhaps using
6155 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
6156 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
6157
6158 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
6159 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
6160
6161 @findex ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE
6162 @item ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
6163 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6164 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
6165 which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
6166 function. The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
6167 representing the function.
6168
6169 If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
6170
6171 @findex ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME
6172 @item ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
6173 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6174 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
6175 initialized variable which is being defined. This macro must output the
6176 label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument
6177 @var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
6178
6179 If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
6180 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
6181
6182 @findex ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL
6183 @item ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
6184 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6185 @var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
6186 for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
6187
6188 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
6189 nothing.
6190
6191 @findex ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT
6192 @item ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
6193 A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
6194 once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
6195 chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
6196 initializer. This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
6197 something about the size of the object.
6198
6199 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
6200 nothing.
6201
6202 @findex ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL
6203 @item ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6204 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6205 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
6206 that is, available for reference from other files. Use the expression
6207 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
6208 itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
6209 for making that name global, and a newline.
6210
6211 @findex ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL
6212 @item ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL
6213 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6214 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
6215 that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
6216 no other definition is available. Use the expression
6217 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
6218 itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
6219 for making that name weak, and a newline.
6220
6221 If you don't define this macro, GCC will not support weak
6222 symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK} macro.
6223
6224 @findex SUPPORTS_WEAK
6225 @item SUPPORTS_WEAK
6226 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
6227
6228 If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
6229 definition. If @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} is defined, the default
6230 definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
6231 you want to control weak symbol support with a compiler flag such as
6232 @option{-melf}.
6233
6234 @findex MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
6235 @item MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY
6236 A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
6237 public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
6238 be discarded by the linker. Define this macro if your object file
6239 format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
6240 section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
6241 requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
6242
6243 @findex SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
6244 @item SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
6245 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
6246 semantics.
6247
6248 If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
6249 definition. If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
6250 definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
6251 you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
6252 setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
6253 be emitted as one-only.
6254
6255 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL
6256 @item ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
6257 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6258 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
6259 symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
6260 not defined. The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
6261 declaration.
6262
6263 This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
6264 The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
6265
6266 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL
6267 @item ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL (@var{stream}, @var{symref})
6268 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output on @var{stream} an assembler
6269 pseudo-op to declare a library function name external. The name of the
6270 library function is given by @var{symref}, which has type @code{rtx} and
6271 is a @code{symbol_ref}.
6272
6273 This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
6274 The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
6275
6276 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF
6277 @item ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6278 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6279 @var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
6280 @var{name}. This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
6281 is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
6282 systems. This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
6283
6284 @ignore @c Seems not to exist anymore.
6285 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF_AS_INT
6286 @item ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF_AS_INT (@var{file}, @var{label})
6287 Define this macro for systems that use the program @code{collect2}.
6288 The definition should be a C statement to output a word containing
6289 a reference to the label @var{label}.
6290 @end ignore
6291
6292 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF
6293 @item ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
6294 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
6295 @code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}. If not defined, @code{assemble_output}
6296 will be used to output the name of the symbol. This macro may be used
6297 to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
6298 encoded by @code{ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
6299
6300 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL
6301 @item ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
6302 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
6303 name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
6304
6305 It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
6306 used for user-level functions and variables. Otherwise, certain programs
6307 will have name conflicts with internal labels.
6308
6309 It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
6310 object file. Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
6311 should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
6312 beginning of a label has this effect. You should find out what
6313 convention your system uses, and follow it.
6314
6315 The usual definition of this macro is as follows:
6316
6317 @example
6318 fprintf (@var{stream}, "L%s%d:\n", @var{prefix}, @var{num})
6319 @end example
6320
6321 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL
6322 @item ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
6323 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
6324 label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
6325 @var{num}. This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
6326 may need to be treated differently than branch target labels. On some
6327 systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
6328 bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
6329 bundles.
6330
6331 If this macro is not defined, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL} will be
6332 used.
6333
6334 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALTERNATE_LABEL_NAME
6335 @item ASM_OUTPUT_ALTERNATE_LABEL_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{string})
6336 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} the string
6337 @var{string}.
6338
6339 The default definition of this macro is as follows:
6340
6341 @example
6342 fprintf (@var{stream}, "%s:\n", LABEL_ALTERNATE_NAME (INSN))
6343 @end example
6344
6345 @findex ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL
6346 @item ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
6347 A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
6348 is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
6349
6350 This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
6351 produce the output that @code{ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL} would produce
6352 with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
6353
6354 If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
6355 output the rest of the string unchanged. It is often convenient for
6356 @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way. If the
6357 string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
6358 to output the string, and may change it. (Of course,
6359 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
6360 you should know what it does on your machine.)
6361
6362 @findex ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME
6363 @item ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
6364 A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
6365 @code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
6366 @var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
6367 added. Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
6368
6369 The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
6370 produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
6371 @var{name}. Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
6372 assembler code. The argument @var{number} is different each time this
6373 macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
6374 internal static variables in different scopes.
6375
6376 Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
6377 conflict with the user's own symbols. Most assemblers allow periods
6378 or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
6379 between the name and the number will suffice.
6380
6381 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_DEF
6382 @item ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
6383 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
6384 which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
6385
6386 @findex SET_ASM_OP
6387 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
6388 correct for most systems.
6389
6390 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS
6391 @item ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
6392 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
6393 which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
6394 to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}. This macro will
6395 be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
6396 the tree nodes are available.
6397
6398 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_DEFINE_LABEL_DIFFERENCE_SYMBOL
6399 @item ASM_OUTPUT_DEFINE_LABEL_DIFFERENCE_SYMBOL (@var{stream}, @var{symbol}, @var{high}, @var{low})
6400 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
6401 which defines (equates) the symbol @var{symbol} to have a value equal to
6402 the difference of the two symbols @var{high} and @var{low},
6403 i.e.@: @var{high} minus @var{low}. GCC guarantees that the symbols @var{high}
6404 and @var{low} are already known by the assembler so that the difference
6405 resolves into a constant.
6406
6407 @findex SET_ASM_OP
6408 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
6409 correct for most systems.
6410
6411 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS
6412 @item ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
6413 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
6414 which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
6415 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
6416 an undefined weak symbol.
6417
6418 Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
6419 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
6420
6421 @findex OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL
6422 @item OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
6423 Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
6424 Objective-C methods.
6425
6426 The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
6427 class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}). For methods in categories, the name of
6428 the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
6429 @samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
6430
6431 These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
6432 the method's selector is not present in the name. Therefore, particular
6433 systems define other ways of computing names.
6434
6435 @var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
6436 buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
6437 @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
6438 50 characters extra.
6439
6440 The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
6441 method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
6442 @var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or NULL if the method is not
6443 in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
6444
6445 On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
6446 macro to provide more human-readable names.
6447
6448 @findex ASM_DECLARE_CLASS_REFERENCE
6449 @item ASM_DECLARE_CLASS_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6450 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6451 @var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
6452 Objective-C class reference. This is only needed for targets whose
6453 linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
6454
6455 @findex ASM_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_REFERENCE
6456 @item ASM_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6457 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6458 @var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
6459 unresolved Objective-C class reference. This is only needed for targets
6460 whose linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
6461 @end table
6462
6463 @node Initialization
6464 @subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
6465 @cindex initialization routines
6466 @cindex termination routines
6467 @cindex constructors, output of
6468 @cindex destructors, output of
6469
6470 The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
6471 (also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
6472 data in the program when the program is started. These functions need
6473 to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
6474 @code{main} is called.
6475
6476 Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
6477 @dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
6478 terminates.
6479
6480 To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
6481 must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
6482 be called at the appropriate time. When you port the compiler to a new
6483 system, you need to specify how to do this.
6484
6485 There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
6486 initialization and termination functions. Each way has two variants.
6487 Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
6488
6489 @findex __CTOR_LIST__
6490 @findex __DTOR_LIST__
6491 The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
6492 initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
6493 termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
6494
6495 Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
6496 0, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
6497 the environment). This is followed by a series of zero or more function
6498 pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
6499 pointer containing zero.
6500
6501 Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
6502 @file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
6503 time and exit time. Constructors are called in reverse order of the
6504 list; destructors in forward order.
6505
6506 The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
6507 formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections. A section is set
6508 aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
6509 Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}. Each
6510 object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
6511 the constructor section to point to that function. The linker
6512 accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
6513 Termination functions are handled similarly.
6514
6515 To use this method, you need appropriate definitions of the macros
6516 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_CONSTRUCTOR} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DESTRUCTOR}. Usually
6517 you can get them by including @file{svr4.h}.
6518
6519 When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
6520 upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called. On systems that
6521 support an @dfn{init} section which is executed at program startup,
6522 parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section. The
6523 program is linked by the @code{gcc} driver like this:
6524
6525 @example
6526 ld -o @var{output_file} crtbegin.o @dots{} crtend.o -lgcc
6527 @end example
6528
6529 The head of a function (@code{__do_global_ctors}) appears in the init
6530 section of @file{crtbegin.o}; the remainder of the function appears in
6531 the init section of @file{crtend.o}. The linker will pull these two
6532 parts of the section together, making a whole function. If any of the
6533 user's object files linked into the middle of it contribute code, then that
6534 code will be executed as part of the body of @code{__do_global_ctors}.
6535
6536 To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
6537 macro properly.
6538
6539 If no init section is available, do not define
6540 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. Then @code{__do_global_ctors} is built into
6541 the text section like all other functions, and resides in
6542 @file{libgcc.a}. When GCC compiles any function called @code{main}, it
6543 inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
6544 after the function prologue. The @code{__main} function, also defined
6545 in @file{libgcc2.c}, simply calls @file{__do_global_ctors}.
6546
6547 In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
6548 two variants. In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
6549 and an `a.out' format must be used. In this case,
6550 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
6551 entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
6552 and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
6553 code as its value. The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
6554 the value to a ``set''; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
6555 placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
6556 a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
6557 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly. Since no init
6558 section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
6559 the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
6560 the initialization process.
6561
6562 The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
6563 This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
6564 file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@. In
6565 this case, @code{ASM_OUTPUT_CONSTRUCTOR} does not produce an
6566 @code{N_SETT} symbol; initialization and termination functions are
6567 recognized simply by their names. This requires an extra program in the
6568 linkage step, called @code{collect2}. This program pretends to be the
6569 linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running the ordinary
6570 linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of initialization and
6571 termination functions. These functions are called via @code{__main} as
6572 described above.
6573
6574 Choosing among these configuration options has been simplified by a set
6575 of operating-system-dependent files in the @file{config} subdirectory.
6576 These files define all of the relevant parameters. Usually it is
6577 sufficient to include one into your specific machine-dependent
6578 configuration file. These files are:
6579
6580 @table @file
6581 @item aoutos.h
6582 For operating systems using the `a.out' format.
6583
6584 @item next.h
6585 For operating systems using the `MachO' format.
6586
6587 @item svr3.h
6588 For System V Release 3 and similar systems using `COFF' format.
6589
6590 @item svr4.h
6591 For System V Release 4 and similar systems using `ELF' format.
6592
6593 @item vms.h
6594 For the VMS operating system.
6595 @end table
6596
6597 @ifinfo
6598 The following section describes the specific macros that control and
6599 customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
6600 @end ifinfo
6601
6602 @node Macros for Initialization
6603 @subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
6604
6605 Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
6606 and termination functions:
6607
6608 @table @code
6609 @findex INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6610 @item INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6611 If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
6612 operation to identify the following data as initialization code. If not
6613 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. When you are
6614 using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
6615 macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
6616 run the initialization functions.
6617
6618 @item HAS_INIT_SECTION
6619 @findex HAS_INIT_SECTION
6620 If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
6621 This macro should be defined for systems that control the contents of the
6622 init section on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
6623 be defined explicitly for systems that support
6624 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6625
6626 @item LD_INIT_SWITCH
6627 @findex LD_INIT_SWITCH
6628 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
6629 the following symbol is an initialization routine.
6630
6631 @item LD_FINI_SWITCH
6632 @findex LD_FINI_SWITCH
6633 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
6634 the following symbol is a finalization routine.
6635
6636 @item INVOKE__main
6637 @findex INVOKE__main
6638 If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
6639 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. This macro should be defined for systems
6640 where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
6641 useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
6642
6643 @item SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
6644 @findex SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
6645 If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
6646 compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
6647 of objects. If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
6648 encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
6649
6650 @item ASM_OUTPUT_CONSTRUCTOR (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6651 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_CONSTRUCTOR
6652 Define this macro as a C statement to output on the stream @var{stream}
6653 the assembler code to arrange to call the function named @var{name} at
6654 initialization time.
6655
6656 Assume that @var{name} is the name of a C function generated
6657 automatically by the compiler. This function takes no arguments. Use
6658 the function @code{assemble_name} to output the name @var{name}; this
6659 performs any system-specific syntactic transformations such as adding an
6660 underscore.
6661
6662 If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output to arrange to
6663 call the function. This is correct when the function will be called in
6664 some other manner---for example, by means of the @code{collect2} program,
6665 which looks through the symbol table to find these functions by their
6666 names.
6667
6668 @item ASM_OUTPUT_DESTRUCTOR (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6669 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_DESTRUCTOR
6670 This is like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
6671 functions rather than initialization functions.
6672
6673 When @code{ASM_OUTPUT_CONSTRUCTOR} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DESTRUCTOR} are
6674 defined, the initialization routine generated for the generated object
6675 file will have static linkage.
6676 @end table
6677
6678 If your system uses @code{collect2} as the means of processing
6679 constructors, then that program normally uses @code{nm} to scan an
6680 object file for constructor functions to be called. On such systems you
6681 must not define @code{ASM_OUTPUT_CONSTRUCTOR} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DESTRUCTOR}
6682 as the object file's initialization routine must have global scope.
6683
6684 On certain kinds of systems, you can define these macros to make
6685 @code{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
6686
6687 @table @code
6688 @findex OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
6689 @item OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
6690 Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
6691 object files, so that @code{collect2} can assume this format and scan
6692 object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
6693
6694 @findex OBJECT_FORMAT_ROSE
6695 @item OBJECT_FORMAT_ROSE
6696 Define this macro if the system uses ROSE format object files, so that
6697 @code{collect2} can assume this format and scan object files directly
6698 for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
6699
6700 These macros are effective only in a native compiler; @code{collect2} as
6701 part of a cross compiler always uses @code{nm} for the target machine.
6702
6703 @findex REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
6704 @item REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
6705 Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
6706 to execute @code{nm}. The default is to search the path normally for
6707 @code{nm}.
6708
6709 If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
6710 dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
6711 these macros to enable support for running initialization and
6712 termination functions in shared libraries:
6713
6714 @findex LDD_SUFFIX
6715 @item LDD_SUFFIX
6716 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the
6717 program which lists dynamic dependencies, like @code{"ldd"} under SunOS 4.
6718
6719 @findex PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT
6720 @item PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
6721 Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
6722 of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. @var{ptr} is a variable
6723 of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
6724 from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
6725 code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
6726 line. Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
6727
6728 @end table
6729
6730 @node Instruction Output
6731 @subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
6732
6733 @c prevent bad page break with this line
6734 This describes assembler instruction output.
6735
6736 @table @code
6737 @findex REGISTER_NAMES
6738 @item REGISTER_NAMES
6739 A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
6740 registers, each one as a C string constant. This is what translates
6741 register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
6742
6743 @findex ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
6744 @item ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
6745 If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
6746 and a register number. This macro defines additional names for hard
6747 registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
6748 to registers using alternate names.
6749
6750 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE
6751 @item ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
6752 Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
6753 requires different names for the machine instructions.
6754
6755 The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
6756 assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}. The
6757 macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
6758 points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
6759 written in the machine description. The definition should output the
6760 opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
6761 increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
6762 so that it will not be output twice.
6763
6764 In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
6765 name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
6766 that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
6767 care of the substitution yourself. Just be sure to increment
6768 @var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
6769
6770 @findex recog_operand
6771 If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
6772 elements of @code{recog_operand}.
6773
6774 If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
6775 in the usual way.
6776
6777 @findex FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN
6778 @item FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
6779 If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
6780 assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
6781 they will be output differently.
6782
6783 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
6784 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
6785 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
6786 The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
6787 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
6788 by changing the contents of the vector.
6789
6790 This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
6791 file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
6792 can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
6793 as with rearranged operands). Naturally, variations in assembler
6794 syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
6795 writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
6796
6797 If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
6798
6799 @findex FINAL_PRESCAN_LABEL
6800 @item FINAL_PRESCAN_LABEL
6801 If defined, @code{FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN} will be called on each
6802 @code{CODE_LABEL}. In that case, @var{opvec} will be a null pointer and
6803 @var{noperands} will be zero.
6804
6805 @findex PRINT_OPERAND
6806 @item PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
6807 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
6808 assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}. @var{x} is an
6809 RTL expression.
6810
6811 @var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
6812 of printing the operand. It is used when identical operands must be
6813 printed differently depending on the context. @var{code} comes from
6814 the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
6815 operand. If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
6816 @var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
6817 @var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
6818
6819 @findex reg_names
6820 If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
6821 The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
6822 @code{char *[]}. @code{reg_names} is initialized from
6823 @code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
6824
6825 When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
6826 (a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
6827 with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
6828 @var{code}.
6829
6830 @findex PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P
6831 @item PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
6832 A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
6833 punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. If
6834 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
6835 punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
6836 in this way.
6837
6838 @findex PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS
6839 @item PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
6840 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
6841 assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
6842 whose address is @var{x}. @var{x} is an RTL expression.
6843
6844 @cindex @code{ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
6845 On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
6846 section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the macro
6847 @code{ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
6848 @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. @xref{Assembler Format}.
6849
6850 @findex DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND
6851 @findex dbr_sequence_length
6852 @item DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND(@var{file})
6853 A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
6854 been output. If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
6855 determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
6856 currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
6857 or whatever.
6858
6859 Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
6860 reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
6861 explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
6862
6863 @findex final_sequence
6864 Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
6865 prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
6866 (i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
6867 found.) The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
6868 processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
6869 being output.
6870
6871 @findex REGISTER_PREFIX
6872 @findex LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
6873 @findex USER_LABEL_PREFIX
6874 @findex IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
6875 @findex asm_fprintf
6876 @item REGISTER_PREFIX
6877 @itemx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
6878 @itemx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
6879 @itemx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
6880 If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
6881 @samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
6882 @file{final.c}). These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
6883 support multiple assembler formats. In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
6884 files can define these macros differently.
6885
6886 @item ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS(@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
6887 @findex ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS
6888 If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
6889 statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
6890 the @code{asm_fprintf} function. This allows targets to define extra
6891 printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
6892 statements. Note that upper case letters are reserved for future
6893 generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
6894 specific code. The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
6895 The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
6896 string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
6897 upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
6898
6899 @findex ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
6900 @item ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
6901 If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
6902 different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
6903 numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
6904 first variant.
6905
6906 If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
6907 @samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}} in the output
6908 templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the first argument
6909 of @code{asm_fprintf}. This construct outputs @samp{option0},
6910 @samp{option1} or @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
6911 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one or two, etc. Any special
6912 characters within these strings retain their usual meaning.
6913
6914 If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
6915 @samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
6916 operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
6917
6918 Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
6919 @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
6920 the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism. Define
6921 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
6922 if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
6923 opcodes or operand order.
6924
6925 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH
6926 @item ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
6927 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
6928 which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
6929 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
6930 profiling.
6931
6932 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP
6933 @item ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
6934 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
6935 which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
6936 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
6937 profiling.
6938 @end table
6939
6940 @node Dispatch Tables
6941 @subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
6942
6943 @c prevent bad page break with this line
6944 This concerns dispatch tables.
6945
6946 @table @code
6947 @cindex dispatch table
6948 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT
6949 @item ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
6950 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
6951 pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
6952 @var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels. The
6953 definitions of these labels are output using
6954 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL}, and they must be printed in the same
6955 way here. For example,
6956
6957 @example
6958 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
6959 @var{value}, @var{rel})
6960 @end example
6961
6962 You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
6963 dispatch table are relative to the table's own address. If defined, GCC
6964 will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
6965 @var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
6966 mode and flags can be read.
6967
6968 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT
6969 @item ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
6970 This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
6971 in a dispatch table are absolute.
6972
6973 The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
6974 @var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
6975 a label. @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
6976 definition is output using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
6977 For example,
6978
6979 @example
6980 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
6981 @end example
6982
6983 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL
6984 @item ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
6985 Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
6986 specially. The first three arguments are the same as for
6987 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL}; the fourth argument is the
6988 jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_insn} containing an
6989 @code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
6990
6991 This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
6992 for the table.
6993
6994 If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
6995 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
6996
6997 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END
6998 @item ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
6999 Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
7000 jump-table. The definition should be a C statement to be executed
7001 after the assembler code for the table is written. It should write
7002 the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}. The argument
7003 @var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
7004 of the preceding label.
7005
7006 If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
7007 the jump-table.
7008 @end table
7009
7010 @node Exception Region Output
7011 @subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
7012
7013 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7014
7015 This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
7016 region.
7017
7018 @table @code
7019 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_EH_REGION_BEG
7020 @item ASM_OUTPUT_EH_REGION_BEG ()
7021 A C expression to output text to mark the start of an exception region.
7022
7023 This macro need not be defined on most platforms.
7024
7025 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_EH_REGION_END
7026 @item ASM_OUTPUT_EH_REGION_END ()
7027 A C expression to output text to mark the end of an exception region.
7028
7029 This macro need not be defined on most platforms.
7030
7031 @findex EXCEPTION_SECTION
7032 @item EXCEPTION_SECTION ()
7033 A C expression to switch to the section in which the main
7034 exception table is to be placed (@pxref{Sections}). The default is a
7035 section named @code{.gcc_except_table} on machines that support named
7036 sections via @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SECTION_NAME}, otherwise if @option{-fpic}
7037 or @option{-fPIC} is in effect, the @code{data_section}, otherwise the
7038 @code{readonly_data_section}.
7039
7040 @findex EH_FRAME_SECTION_ASM_OP
7041 @item EH_FRAME_SECTION_ASM_OP
7042 If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
7043 operation to switch to the section for exception handling frame unwind
7044 information. If not defined, GCC will provide a default definition if the
7045 target supports named sections. @file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to
7046 switch to the appropriate section.
7047
7048 You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
7049 unwind information and the default definition does not work.
7050
7051 @findex OMIT_EH_TABLE
7052 @item OMIT_EH_TABLE ()
7053 A C expression that is nonzero if the normal exception table output
7054 should be omitted.
7055
7056 This macro need not be defined on most platforms.
7057
7058 @findex EH_TABLE_LOOKUP
7059 @item EH_TABLE_LOOKUP ()
7060 Alternate runtime support for looking up an exception at runtime and
7061 finding the associated handler, if the default method won't work.
7062
7063 This macro need not be defined on most platforms.
7064
7065 @findex DOESNT_NEED_UNWINDER
7066 @item DOESNT_NEED_UNWINDER
7067 A C expression that decides whether or not the current function needs to
7068 have a function unwinder generated for it. See the file @file{except.c}
7069 for details on when to define this, and how.
7070
7071 @findex MASK_RETURN_ADDR
7072 @item MASK_RETURN_ADDR
7073 An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
7074 that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
7075
7076 @findex DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
7077 @item DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
7078 Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
7079 information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
7080 Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
7081 @samp{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either @samp{UNALIGNED_INT_ASM_OP}
7082 or @samp{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}), GCC will provide a default definition of
7083 1.
7084
7085 If this macro is defined to 1, the DWARF 2 unwinder will be the default
7086 exception handling mechanism; otherwise, @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} will be used by
7087 default.
7088
7089 If this macro is defined to anything, the DWARF 2 unwinder will be used
7090 instead of inline unwinders and @code{__unwind_function} in the non-@code{setjmp} case.
7091
7092 @findex DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
7093 @item DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
7094 This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
7095 function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
7096 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. The definition should be the negative minimum
7097 alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and the positive
7098 minimum alignment otherwise. @xref{SDB and DWARF}. Only applicable if
7099 the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
7100
7101 @end table
7102
7103 @node Alignment Output
7104 @subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
7105
7106 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7107 This describes commands for alignment.
7108
7109 @table @code
7110 @findex LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER
7111 @item LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
7112 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
7113 a @code{BARRIER}.
7114
7115 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
7116 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
7117 define the macro.
7118
7119 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
7120 to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
7121 @code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS}. Otherwise, you should try to honour the user's
7122 selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}
7123 implementation.
7124
7125 @findex LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP
7126 @item LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP
7127 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying
7128 @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}. This works only if
7129 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
7130
7131 @findex LOOP_ALIGN
7132 @item LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
7133 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
7134 a @code{NOTE_INSN_LOOP_BEG} note.
7135
7136 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
7137 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
7138 define the macro.
7139
7140 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
7141 to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
7142 @code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS}. Otherwise, you should try to honour the user's
7143 selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
7144
7145 @findex LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
7146 @item LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
7147 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN}.
7148 This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
7149
7150 @findex LABEL_ALIGN
7151 @item LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
7152 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
7153 If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
7154 the maximum of the specified values is used.
7155
7156 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
7157 to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
7158 @code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS}. Otherwise, you should try to honour the user's
7159 selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
7160
7161 @findex LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
7162 @item LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
7163 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}.
7164 This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
7165
7166 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP
7167 @item ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
7168 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7169 instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
7170 Those bytes should be zero when loaded. @var{nbytes} will be a C
7171 expression of type @code{int}.
7172
7173 @findex ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
7174 @item ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
7175 Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
7176 text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
7177 This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
7178 produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
7179 section.
7180
7181 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN
7182 @item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
7183 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7184 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
7185 @var{power} bytes. @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
7186
7187 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN
7188 @item ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
7189 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7190 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
7191 @var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
7192 satisfy the alignment request. @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
7193 a C expression of type @code{int}.
7194 @end table
7195
7196 @need 3000
7197 @node Debugging Info
7198 @section Controlling Debugging Information Format
7199
7200 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7201 This describes how to specify debugging information.
7202
7203 @menu
7204 * All Debuggers:: Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
7205 * DBX Options:: Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
7206 * DBX Hooks:: Hook macros for varying DBX format.
7207 * File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
7208 * SDB and DWARF:: Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
7209 @end menu
7210
7211 @node All Debuggers
7212 @subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
7213
7214 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7215 These macros affect all debugging formats.
7216
7217 @table @code
7218 @findex DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER
7219 @item DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
7220 A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
7221 register number @var{regno}. In simple cases, the value of this
7222 expression may be @var{regno} itself. But sometimes there are some
7223 registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
7224 versa. In such cases, some register may need to have one number in
7225 the compiler and another for DBX@.
7226
7227 If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
7228 used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
7229 consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
7230 Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
7231 expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
7232
7233 If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
7234 does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
7235 redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
7236
7237 @findex DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET
7238 @item DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
7239 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
7240 variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The default
7241 computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
7242 gives the offset from the frame-pointer. This is required for targets
7243 that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
7244 for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
7245 @option{-g} options is used.
7246
7247 @findex DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET
7248 @item DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
7249 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
7250 having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The nominal offset is
7251 @var{offset}.
7252
7253 @findex PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
7254 @item PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
7255 A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
7256 produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}. Define
7257 this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
7258 debugging output. Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
7259 @code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}, and
7260 @code{XCOFF_DEBUG}.
7261
7262 When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
7263 value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
7264 exceptions. If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined and
7265 @code{LINKER_DOES_NOT_WORK_WITH_DWARF2} is not defined, GCC uses the
7266 value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}. Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
7267 defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
7268
7269 The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
7270 user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
7271 @option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-1}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, or @option{-gxcoff}.
7272 @end table
7273
7274 @node DBX Options
7275 @subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
7276
7277 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7278 These are specific options for DBX output.
7279
7280 @table @code
7281 @findex DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
7282 @item DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
7283 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
7284 in response to the @option{-g} option.
7285
7286 @findex XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
7287 @item XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
7288 Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
7289 in response to the @option{-g} option. This is a variant of DBX format.
7290
7291 @findex DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
7292 @item DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
7293 Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
7294 GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
7295 debugging information is enabled at all). If you don't define the
7296 macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
7297 if there is any occasion to.
7298
7299 @findex DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
7300 @item DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
7301 Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
7302 in the text section.
7303
7304 @findex ASM_STABS_OP
7305 @item ASM_STABS_OP
7306 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
7307 use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
7308 If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used. This macro
7309 applies only to DBX debugging information format.
7310
7311 @findex ASM_STABD_OP
7312 @item ASM_STABD_OP
7313 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
7314 use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
7315 value is the current location. If you don't define this macro,
7316 @code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used. This macro applies only to DBX debugging
7317 information format.
7318
7319 @findex ASM_STABN_OP
7320 @item ASM_STABN_OP
7321 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
7322 use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
7323 name. If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used. This
7324 macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
7325
7326 @findex DBX_NO_XREFS
7327 @item DBX_NO_XREFS
7328 Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
7329 @samp{xs@var{tagname}}. On some systems, this construct is used to
7330 describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
7331 On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
7332
7333 @findex DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
7334 @item DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
7335 A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
7336 continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
7337 exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters). On some
7338 operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
7339 must not be done. You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
7340 with the value zero. You can override the default splitting-length by
7341 defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
7342
7343 @findex DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
7344 @item DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
7345 Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
7346 the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows. To use
7347 a different character instead, define this macro as a character
7348 constant for the character you want to use. Do not define this macro
7349 if backslash is correct for your system.
7350
7351 @findex DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
7352 @item DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
7353 Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
7354 outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
7355 variable.
7356
7357 @findex DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
7358 @item DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
7359 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
7360 for a typedef. The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
7361
7362 @findex DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
7363 @item DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
7364 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
7365 for a static variable located in the text section. DBX format does not
7366 provide any ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_FUN}.
7367
7368 @findex DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
7369 @item DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
7370 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
7371 for a parameter passed in registers. DBX format does not provide any
7372 ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
7373
7374 @findex DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
7375 @item DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
7376 The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
7377 passed in registers. DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
7378 do this. The default is @code{'P'}.
7379
7380 @findex DBX_MEMPARM_STABS_LETTER
7381 @item DBX_MEMPARM_STABS_LETTER
7382 The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a stack
7383 parameter. The default is @code{'p'}.
7384
7385 @findex DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
7386 @item DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
7387 Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
7388 arguments should precede the assembler code for the function. Normally,
7389 in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
7390 code.
7391
7392 @findex DBX_LBRAC_FIRST
7393 @item DBX_LBRAC_FIRST
7394 Define this macro if the @code{N_LBRAC} symbol for a block should
7395 precede the debugging information for variables and functions defined in
7396 that block. Normally, in DBX format, the @code{N_LBRAC} symbol comes
7397 first.
7398
7399 @findex DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
7400 @item DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
7401 Define this macro if the value of a symbol describing the scope of a
7402 block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be relative to the start
7403 of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
7404
7405 @findex DBX_USE_BINCL
7406 @item DBX_USE_BINCL
7407 Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
7408 @code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems. This
7409 macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
7410 number and a type number within the file. Normally, GCC does not
7411 generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
7412 number for a type number.
7413 @end table
7414
7415 @node DBX Hooks
7416 @subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
7417
7418 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7419 These are hooks for DBX format.
7420
7421 @table @code
7422 @findex DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC
7423 @item DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7424 Define this macro to say how to output to @var{stream} the debugging
7425 information for the start of a scope level for variable names. The
7426 argument @var{name} is the name of an assembler symbol (for use with
7427 @code{assemble_name}) whose value is the address where the scope begins.
7428
7429 @findex DBX_OUTPUT_RBRAC
7430 @item DBX_OUTPUT_RBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7431 Like @code{DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC}, but for the end of a scope level.
7432
7433 @findex DBX_OUTPUT_ENUM
7434 @item DBX_OUTPUT_ENUM (@var{stream}, @var{type})
7435 Define this macro if the target machine requires special handling to
7436 output an enumeration type. The definition should be a C statement
7437 (sans semicolon) to output the appropriate information to @var{stream}
7438 for the type @var{type}.
7439
7440 @findex DBX_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_END
7441 @item DBX_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_END (@var{stream}, @var{function})
7442 Define this macro if the target machine requires special output at the
7443 end of the debugging information for a function. The definition should
7444 be a C statement (sans semicolon) to output the appropriate information
7445 to @var{stream}. @var{function} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} node for
7446 the function.
7447
7448 @findex DBX_OUTPUT_STANDARD_TYPES
7449 @item DBX_OUTPUT_STANDARD_TYPES (@var{syms})
7450 Define this macro if you need to control the order of output of the
7451 standard data types at the beginning of compilation. The argument
7452 @var{syms} is a @code{tree} which is a chain of all the predefined
7453 global symbols, including names of data types.
7454
7455 Normally, DBX output starts with definitions of the types for integers
7456 and characters, followed by all the other predefined types of the
7457 particular language in no particular order.
7458
7459 On some machines, it is necessary to output different particular types
7460 first. To do this, define @code{DBX_OUTPUT_STANDARD_TYPES} to output
7461 those symbols in the necessary order. Any predefined types that you
7462 don't explicitly output will be output afterward in no particular order.
7463
7464 Be careful not to define this macro so that it works only for C@. There
7465 are no global variables to access most of the built-in types, because
7466 another language may have another set of types. The way to output a
7467 particular type is to look through @var{syms} to see if you can find it.
7468 Here is an example:
7469
7470 @smallexample
7471 @{
7472 tree decl;
7473 for (decl = syms; decl; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
7474 if (!strcmp (IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (decl)),
7475 "long int"))
7476 dbxout_symbol (decl);
7477 @dots{}
7478 @}
7479 @end smallexample
7480
7481 @noindent
7482 This does nothing if the expected type does not exist.
7483
7484 See the function @code{init_decl_processing} in @file{c-decl.c} to find
7485 the names to use for all the built-in C types.
7486
7487 Here is another way of finding a particular type:
7488
7489 @c this is still overfull. --mew 10feb93
7490 @smallexample
7491 @{
7492 tree decl;
7493 for (decl = syms; decl; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
7494 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL
7495 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))
7496 == INTEGER_CST)
7497 && TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == 16
7498 && TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
7499 @group
7500 /* @r{This must be @code{unsigned short}.} */
7501 dbxout_symbol (decl);
7502 @dots{}
7503 @}
7504 @end group
7505 @end smallexample
7506
7507 @findex NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
7508 @item NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
7509 Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
7510 @code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
7511 On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
7512 disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
7513
7514 @end table
7515
7516 @node File Names and DBX
7517 @subsection File Names in DBX Format
7518
7519 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7520 This describes file names in DBX format.
7521
7522 @table @code
7523 @findex DBX_WORKING_DIRECTORY
7524 @item DBX_WORKING_DIRECTORY
7525 Define this if DBX wants to have the current directory recorded in each
7526 object file.
7527
7528 Note that the working directory is always recorded if GDB extensions are
7529 enabled.
7530
7531 @findex DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME
7532 @item DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7533 A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
7534 @var{stream} which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
7535 file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
7536 This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
7537
7538 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7539 for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
7540
7541 @findex DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
7542 @item DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7543 A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
7544 @var{stream} which indicates that the current directory during
7545 compilation is named @var{name}.
7546
7547 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7548 for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
7549
7550 @findex DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
7551 @item DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7552 A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
7553 compilation of the main source file @var{name}.
7554
7555 If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
7556 of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
7557
7558 @findex DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME
7559 @item DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7560 A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
7561 @var{stream} which indicates that file @var{name} is the current source
7562 file. This output is generated each time input shifts to a different
7563 source file as a result of @samp{#include}, the end of an included file,
7564 or a @samp{#line} command.
7565
7566 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7567 for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
7568 @end table
7569
7570 @need 2000
7571 @node SDB and DWARF
7572 @subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
7573
7574 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7575 Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
7576
7577 @table @code
7578 @findex SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
7579 @item SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
7580 Define this macro if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
7581 for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
7582
7583 @findex DWARF_DEBUGGING_INFO
7584 @item DWARF_DEBUGGING_INFO
7585 Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf format debugging output
7586 in response to the @option{-g} option.
7587
7588 @findex DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
7589 @item DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
7590 Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
7591 debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
7592
7593 To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
7594 define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
7595 @code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
7596 prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
7597 as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
7598
7599 @findex DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
7600 @item DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
7601 Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
7602 Dwarf 2 frame information. If @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}
7603 (@pxref{Exception Region Output} is nonzero, GCC will output this
7604 information not matter how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
7605
7606 @findex LINKER_DOES_NOT_WORK_WITH_DWARF2
7607 @item LINKER_DOES_NOT_WORK_WITH_DWARF2
7608 Define this macro if the linker does not work with Dwarf version 2.
7609 Normally, if the user specifies only @option{-ggdb} GCC will use Dwarf
7610 version 2 if available; this macro disables this. See the description
7611 of the @code{PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE} macro for more details.
7612
7613 @findex DWARF2_GENERATE_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
7614 @item DWARF2_GENERATE_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
7615 By default, the Dwarf 2 debugging information generator will generate a
7616 label to mark the beginning of the text section. If it is better simply
7617 to use the name of the text section itself, rather than an explicit label,
7618 to indicate the beginning of the text section, define this macro to zero.
7619
7620 @findex DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
7621 @item DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
7622 Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
7623 line debug info sections. This will result in much more compact line number
7624 tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
7625
7626 @findex PUT_SDB_@dots{}
7627 @item PUT_SDB_@dots{}
7628 Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
7629 SDB assembler directives. See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
7630 macros and their arguments. If the standard syntax is used, you need
7631 not define them yourself.
7632
7633 @findex SDB_DELIM
7634 @item SDB_DELIM
7635 Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
7636 SDB assembler directives. In that case, define this macro to be the
7637 delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}). It is not necessary to define
7638 a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
7639 required.
7640
7641 @findex SDB_GENERATE_FAKE
7642 @item SDB_GENERATE_FAKE
7643 Define this macro to override the usual method of constructing a dummy
7644 name for anonymous structure and union types. See @file{sdbout.c} for
7645 more information.
7646
7647 @findex SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
7648 @item SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
7649 Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
7650 union, or enumeration tags to be emitted. Standard COFF does not
7651 allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
7652 it.
7653
7654 @findex SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
7655 @item SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
7656 Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
7657 enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled. Some
7658 assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
7659 @end table
7660
7661 @node Cross-compilation
7662 @section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
7663 @cindex cross compilation and floating point
7664 @cindex floating point and cross compilation
7665
7666 While all modern machines use 2's complement representation for integers,
7667 there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers. This
7668 means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
7669 in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
7670 doing the compilation.
7671
7672 @findex atof
7673 Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
7674 range and precision, the cross compiler cannot safely use the host
7675 machine's floating point arithmetic. Therefore, floating point constants
7676 must be represented in the target machine's format. This means that the
7677 cross compiler cannot use @code{atof} to parse a floating point constant;
7678 it must have its own special routine to use instead. Also, constant
7679 folding must emulate the target machine's arithmetic (or must not be done
7680 at all).
7681
7682 The macros in the following table should be defined only if you are cross
7683 compiling between different floating point formats.
7684
7685 Otherwise, don't define them. Then default definitions will be set up which
7686 use @code{double} as the data type, @code{==} to test for equality, etc.
7687
7688 You don't need to worry about how many times you use an operand of any
7689 of these macros. The compiler never uses operands which have side effects.
7690
7691 @table @code
7692 @findex REAL_VALUE_TYPE
7693 @item REAL_VALUE_TYPE
7694 A macro for the C data type to be used to hold a floating point value
7695 in the target machine's format. Typically this would be a
7696 @code{struct} containing an array of @code{int}.
7697
7698 @findex REAL_VALUES_EQUAL
7699 @item REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (@var{x}, @var{y})
7700 A macro for a C expression which compares for equality the two values,
7701 @var{x} and @var{y}, both of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}.
7702
7703 @findex REAL_VALUES_LESS
7704 @item REAL_VALUES_LESS (@var{x}, @var{y})
7705 A macro for a C expression which tests whether @var{x} is less than
7706 @var{y}, both values being of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} and
7707 interpreted as floating point numbers in the target machine's
7708 representation.
7709
7710 @findex REAL_VALUE_LDEXP
7711 @findex ldexp
7712 @item REAL_VALUE_LDEXP (@var{x}, @var{scale})
7713 A macro for a C expression which performs the standard library
7714 function @code{ldexp}, but using the target machine's floating point
7715 representation. Both @var{x} and the value of the expression have
7716 type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}. The second argument, @var{scale}, is an
7717 integer.
7718
7719 @findex REAL_VALUE_FIX
7720 @item REAL_VALUE_FIX (@var{x})
7721 A macro whose definition is a C expression to convert the target-machine
7722 floating point value @var{x} to a signed integer. @var{x} has type
7723 @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}.
7724
7725 @findex REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX
7726 @item REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (@var{x})
7727 A macro whose definition is a C expression to convert the target-machine
7728 floating point value @var{x} to an unsigned integer. @var{x} has type
7729 @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}.
7730
7731 @findex REAL_VALUE_RNDZINT
7732 @item REAL_VALUE_RNDZINT (@var{x})
7733 A macro whose definition is a C expression to round the target-machine
7734 floating point value @var{x} towards zero to an integer value (but still
7735 as a floating point number). @var{x} has type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE},
7736 and so does the value.
7737
7738 @findex REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_RNDZINT
7739 @item REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_RNDZINT (@var{x})
7740 A macro whose definition is a C expression to round the target-machine
7741 floating point value @var{x} towards zero to an unsigned integer value
7742 (but still represented as a floating point number). @var{x} has type
7743 @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, and so does the value.
7744
7745 @findex REAL_VALUE_ATOF
7746 @item REAL_VALUE_ATOF (@var{string}, @var{mode})
7747 A macro for a C expression which converts @var{string}, an expression of
7748 type @code{char *}, into a floating point number in the target machine's
7749 representation for mode @var{mode}. The value has type
7750 @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}.
7751
7752 @findex REAL_INFINITY
7753 @item REAL_INFINITY
7754 Define this macro if infinity is a possible floating point value, and
7755 therefore division by 0 is legitimate.
7756
7757 @findex REAL_VALUE_ISINF
7758 @findex isinf
7759 @item REAL_VALUE_ISINF (@var{x})
7760 A macro for a C expression which determines whether @var{x}, a floating
7761 point value, is infinity. The value has type @code{int}.
7762 By default, this is defined to call @code{isinf}.
7763
7764 @findex REAL_VALUE_ISNAN
7765 @findex isnan
7766 @item REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (@var{x})
7767 A macro for a C expression which determines whether @var{x}, a floating
7768 point value, is a ``nan'' (not-a-number). The value has type
7769 @code{int}. By default, this is defined to call @code{isnan}.
7770 @end table
7771
7772 @cindex constant folding and floating point
7773 Define the following additional macros if you want to make floating
7774 point constant folding work while cross compiling. If you don't
7775 define them, cross compilation is still possible, but constant folding
7776 will not happen for floating point values.
7777
7778 @table @code
7779 @findex REAL_ARITHMETIC
7780 @item REAL_ARITHMETIC (@var{output}, @var{code}, @var{x}, @var{y})
7781 A macro for a C statement which calculates an arithmetic operation of
7782 the two floating point values @var{x} and @var{y}, both of type
7783 @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} in the target machine's representation, to
7784 produce a result of the same type and representation which is stored
7785 in @var{output} (which will be a variable).
7786
7787 The operation to be performed is specified by @var{code}, a tree code
7788 which will always be one of the following: @code{PLUS_EXPR},
7789 @code{MINUS_EXPR}, @code{MULT_EXPR}, @code{RDIV_EXPR},
7790 @code{MAX_EXPR}, @code{MIN_EXPR}.
7791
7792 @cindex overflow while constant folding
7793 The expansion of this macro is responsible for checking for overflow.
7794 If overflow happens, the macro expansion should execute the statement
7795 @code{return 0;}, which indicates the inability to perform the
7796 arithmetic operation requested.
7797
7798 @findex REAL_VALUE_NEGATE
7799 @item REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (@var{x})
7800 A macro for a C expression which returns the negative of the floating
7801 point value @var{x}. Both @var{x} and the value of the expression
7802 have type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} and are in the target machine's
7803 floating point representation.
7804
7805 There is no way for this macro to report overflow, since overflow
7806 can't happen in the negation operation.
7807
7808 @findex REAL_VALUE_TRUNCATE
7809 @item REAL_VALUE_TRUNCATE (@var{mode}, @var{x})
7810 A macro for a C expression which converts the floating point value
7811 @var{x} to mode @var{mode}.
7812
7813 Both @var{x} and the value of the expression are in the target machine's
7814 floating point representation and have type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}.
7815 However, the value should have an appropriate bit pattern to be output
7816 properly as a floating constant whose precision accords with mode
7817 @var{mode}.
7818
7819 There is no way for this macro to report overflow.
7820
7821 @findex REAL_VALUE_TO_INT
7822 @item REAL_VALUE_TO_INT (@var{low}, @var{high}, @var{x})
7823 A macro for a C expression which converts a floating point value
7824 @var{x} into a double-precision integer which is then stored into
7825 @var{low} and @var{high}, two variables of type @var{int}.
7826
7827 @item REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT (@var{x}, @var{low}, @var{high}, @var{mode})
7828 @findex REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT
7829 A macro for a C expression which converts a double-precision integer
7830 found in @var{low} and @var{high}, two variables of type @var{int},
7831 into a floating point value which is then stored into @var{x}.
7832 The value is in the target machine's representation for mode @var{mode}
7833 and has the type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}.
7834 @end table
7835
7836 @node Mode Switching
7837 @section Mode Switching Instructions
7838 @cindex mode switching
7839 The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
7840
7841 @table @code
7842 @findex OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING
7843 @item OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
7844 Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
7845 switching in an optimizing compilation.
7846
7847 For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
7848 floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
7849 the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
7850 operation, this bit has to be set. Changing the PR bit requires a general
7851 purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
7852 be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you can't put this into instruction emitting
7853 or @code{MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
7854
7855 You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
7856 which entities actually need it. @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
7857 return non-zero for any @var{entity} that that needs mode-switching.
7858 If you define this macro, you also have to define
7859 @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{MODE_NEEDED},
7860 @code{MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE} and @code{EMIT_MODE_SET}.
7861 @code{NORMAL_MODE} is optional.
7862
7863 @findex NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
7864 @item NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
7865 If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
7866 initializer for an array of integers. Each initializer element
7867 N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
7868 of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
7869 The position of the initializer in the initializer - starting counting at
7870 zero - determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
7871 entity in question.
7872 In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
7873 represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1. N is used to specify that no mode
7874 switch is needed / supplied.
7875
7876 @findex MODE_NEEDED
7877 @item MODE_NEEDED (@var{entity}, @var{insn})
7878 @var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If
7879 @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to
7880 return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in
7881 @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must
7882 be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
7883
7884 @findex NORMAL_MODE
7885 @item NORMAL_MODE (@var{entity})
7886 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
7887 mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
7888 @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry and exit.
7889
7890 @findex MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE
7891 @item MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE (@var{entity}, @var{n})
7892 This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed.
7893 0 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the
7894 lowest. The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode
7895 for @var{entity}. For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority_to_mode}
7896 (@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{}
7897 @code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
7898
7899 @findex EMIT_MODE_SET
7900 @item EMIT_MODE_SET (@var{entity}, @var{mode}, @var{hard_regs_live})
7901 Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}.
7902 @var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where
7903 the insn(s) are to be inserted.
7904 @end table
7905
7906 @node Misc
7907 @section Miscellaneous Parameters
7908 @cindex parameters, miscellaneous
7909
7910 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7911 Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
7912
7913 @table @code
7914 @item PREDICATE_CODES
7915 @findex PREDICATE_CODES
7916 Define this if you have defined special-purpose predicates in the file
7917 @file{@var{machine}.c}. This macro is called within an initializer of an
7918 array of structures. The first field in the structure is the name of a
7919 predicate and the second field is an array of rtl codes. For each
7920 predicate, list all rtl codes that can be in expressions matched by the
7921 predicate. The list should have a trailing comma. Here is an example
7922 of two entries in the list for a typical RISC machine:
7923
7924 @smallexample
7925 #define PREDICATE_CODES \
7926 @{"gen_reg_rtx_operand", @{SUBREG, REG@}@}, \
7927 @{"reg_or_short_cint_operand", @{SUBREG, REG, CONST_INT@}@},
7928 @end smallexample
7929
7930 Defining this macro does not affect the generated code (however,
7931 incorrect definitions that omit an rtl code that may be matched by the
7932 predicate can cause the compiler to malfunction). Instead, it allows
7933 the table built by @file{genrecog} to be more compact and efficient,
7934 thus speeding up the compiler. The most important predicates to include
7935 in the list specified by this macro are those used in the most insn
7936 patterns.
7937
7938 For each predicate function named in @code{PREDICATE_CODES}, a
7939 declaration will be generated in @file{insn-codes.h}.
7940
7941 @item SPECIAL_MODE_PREDICATES
7942 @findex SPECIAL_MODE_PREDICATES
7943 Define this if you have special predicates that know special things
7944 about modes. Genrecog will warn about certain forms of
7945 @code{match_operand} without a mode; if the operand predicate is
7946 listed in @code{SPECIAL_MODE_PREDICATES}, the warning will be
7947 suppressed.
7948
7949 Here is an example from the IA-32 port (@code{ext_register_operand}
7950 specially checks for @code{HImode} or @code{SImode} in preparation
7951 for a byte extraction from @code{%ah} etc.).
7952
7953 @smallexample
7954 #define SPECIAL_MODE_PREDICATES \
7955 "ext_register_operand",
7956 @end smallexample
7957
7958 @findex CASE_VECTOR_MODE
7959 @item CASE_VECTOR_MODE
7960 An alias for a machine mode name. This is the machine mode that
7961 elements of a jump-table should have.
7962
7963 @findex CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE
7964 @item CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
7965 Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
7966 when the minimum and maximum offset are known. If you define this,
7967 it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
7968 To make this work, you also have to define INSN_ALIGN and
7969 make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
7970 The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
7971 flags can be updated.
7972
7973 @findex CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
7974 @item CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
7975 Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
7976 should contain relative addresses. If jump-tables never contain
7977 relative addresses, then you need not define this macro.
7978
7979 @findex CASE_DROPS_THROUGH
7980 @item CASE_DROPS_THROUGH
7981 Define this if control falls through a @code{case} insn when the index
7982 value is out of range. This means the specified default-label is
7983 actually ignored by the @code{case} insn proper.
7984
7985 @findex CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD
7986 @item CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD
7987 Define this to be the smallest number of different values for which it
7988 is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
7989 The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
7990 five otherwise. This is best for most machines.
7991
7992 @findex WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
7993 @item WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
7994 Define this macro if operations between registers with integral mode
7995 smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
7996 Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
7997
7998 @findex LOAD_EXTEND_OP
7999 @item LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mode})
8000 Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
8001 memory in @var{mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
8002 bits outside of @var{mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
8003 zero-extension of the data read. Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
8004 of @var{mode} for which the
8005 insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
8006 @code{NIL} for other modes.
8007
8008 This macro is not called with @var{mode} non-integral or with a width
8009 greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
8010 value in this case. Do not define this macro if it would always return
8011 @code{NIL}. On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
8012 define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
8013
8014 @findex SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
8015 @item SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
8016 Define this macro if loading short immediate values into registers sign
8017 extends.
8018
8019 @findex IMPLICIT_FIX_EXPR
8020 @item IMPLICIT_FIX_EXPR
8021 An alias for a tree code that should be used by default for conversion
8022 of floating point values to fixed point. Normally,
8023 @code{FIX_ROUND_EXPR} is used.
8024
8025 @findex FIXUNS_TRUNC_LIKE_FIX_TRUNC
8026 @item FIXUNS_TRUNC_LIKE_FIX_TRUNC
8027 Define this macro if the same instructions that convert a floating
8028 point number to a signed fixed point number also convert validly to an
8029 unsigned one.
8030
8031 @findex EASY_DIV_EXPR
8032 @item EASY_DIV_EXPR
8033 An alias for a tree code that is the easiest kind of division to
8034 compile code for in the general case. It may be
8035 @code{TRUNC_DIV_EXPR}, @code{FLOOR_DIV_EXPR}, @code{CEIL_DIV_EXPR} or
8036 @code{ROUND_DIV_EXPR}. These four division operators differ in how
8037 they round the result to an integer. @code{EASY_DIV_EXPR} is used
8038 when it is permissible to use any of those kinds of division and the
8039 choice should be made on the basis of efficiency.
8040
8041 @findex MOVE_MAX
8042 @item MOVE_MAX
8043 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
8044 between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
8045
8046 @findex MAX_MOVE_MAX
8047 @item MAX_MOVE_MAX
8048 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
8049 between memory and registers or between two memory locations. If this
8050 is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}. Otherwise, it is the
8051 constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
8052 at run-time.
8053
8054 @findex SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
8055 @item SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
8056 A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
8057 actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
8058 of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted. When
8059 this macro is non-zero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
8060 a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
8061 truncates the count of a shift operation. On machines that have
8062 instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
8063 include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
8064 also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
8065 arguments to bit-field instructions.
8066
8067 If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
8068 position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
8069 instructions exist, you should define this macro.
8070
8071 However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
8072 only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
8073 bit-field operations. Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
8074 such machines. Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
8075 the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
8076
8077 You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
8078
8079 @findex TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION
8080 @item TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
8081 A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
8082 ``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
8083 bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
8084 operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
8085
8086 On many machines, this expression can be 1.
8087
8088 @c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that". this was
8089 @c to fix an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
8090 When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
8091 modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
8092 If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
8093 such cases may improve things.
8094
8095 @findex STORE_FLAG_VALUE
8096 @item STORE_FLAG_VALUE
8097 A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
8098 with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
8099 (@samp{s@var{cond}}) when the condition is true. This description must
8100 apply to @emph{all} the @samp{s@var{cond}} patterns and all the
8101 comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
8102
8103 A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
8104 comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
8105 and 0 when the comparison is false. Otherwise, the value indicates
8106 which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
8107 true. This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
8108 operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
8109 @samp{s@var{cond}} pattern. Either the low bit or the sign bit of
8110 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on. Presently, only those bits are used by
8111 the compiler.
8112
8113 If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
8114 generate code that depends only on the specified bits. It can also
8115 replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
8116 the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
8117 For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
8118 @code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
8119 @samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
8120 expression
8121
8122 @smallexample
8123 (ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
8124 @end smallexample
8125
8126 @noindent
8127 can be converted to
8128
8129 @smallexample
8130 (ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
8131 @end smallexample
8132
8133 @noindent
8134 where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
8135 tested into the sign bit.
8136
8137 There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
8138 for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
8139 but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction. If you
8140 are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
8141 perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
8142 comparison operators and let us know
8143 @ifset USING
8144 (@pxref{Bug Reporting,,How to Report Bugs}).
8145 @end ifset
8146 @ifclear USING
8147 (@pxref{Bug Reporting,,How to Report Bugs,gcc.info,Using GCC}).
8148 @end ifclear
8149
8150 Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
8151 from a comparison (or the condition codes). Here are rules to guide the
8152 choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
8153 to be used:
8154
8155 @itemize @bullet
8156 @item
8157 Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
8158 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}. It is more efficient for the compiler to
8159 ``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
8160 comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
8161 combine the normalization with other operations.
8162
8163 @item
8164 For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
8165 slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
8166 other machines.
8167
8168 @item
8169 As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
8170 exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
8171 others.
8172
8173 @item
8174 Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
8175 @end itemize
8176
8177 Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
8178 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
8179 instructions. On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
8180 those cases, e.g., one matching
8181
8182 @smallexample
8183 (set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
8184 @end smallexample
8185
8186 Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
8187 condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
8188 @samp{s@var{cond}} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}. On those
8189 machines, define the appropriate patterns. Use the names @code{incscc}
8190 and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
8191 @code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values. See
8192 @file{rs6000.md} for some examples. The GNU Superoptizer can be used to
8193 find such instruction sequences on other machines.
8194
8195 You need not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
8196 instructions.
8197
8198 @findex FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE
8199 @item FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
8200 A C expression that gives a non-zero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
8201 returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
8202 Define this macro on machine that have comparison operations that return
8203 floating-point values. If there are no such operations, do not define
8204 this macro.
8205
8206 @findex Pmode
8207 @item Pmode
8208 An alias for the machine mode for pointers. On most machines, define
8209 this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
8210 pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
8211 On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
8212 modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
8213
8214 The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
8215 @code{POINTER_SIZE}. If it is not equal, you must define the macro
8216 @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
8217 to @code{Pmode}.
8218
8219 @findex FUNCTION_MODE
8220 @item FUNCTION_MODE
8221 An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
8222 being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions. On most machines this
8223 should be @code{QImode}.
8224
8225 @findex INTEGRATE_THRESHOLD
8226 @item INTEGRATE_THRESHOLD (@var{decl})
8227 A C expression for the maximum number of instructions above which the
8228 function @var{decl} should not be inlined. @var{decl} is a
8229 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} node.
8230
8231 The default definition of this macro is 64 plus 8 times the number of
8232 arguments that the function accepts. Some people think a larger
8233 threshold should be used on RISC machines.
8234
8235 @findex STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
8236 @item STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
8237 In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
8238 constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@. On some
8239 hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
8240 where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
8241 strict conformance to the C Standard.
8242
8243 Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
8244 convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
8245 files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
8246
8247 @findex SCCS_DIRECTIVE
8248 @item SCCS_DIRECTIVE
8249 Define this if the preprocessor should ignore @code{#sccs} directives
8250 and print no error message.
8251
8252 @findex NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
8253 @item NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
8254 Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
8255 This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
8256 C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
8257 @samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
8258
8259 @findex HANDLE_PRAGMA
8260 @item HANDLE_PRAGMA (@var{getc}, @var{ungetc}, @var{name})
8261 This macro is no longer supported. You must use
8262 @code{REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS} instead.
8263
8264 @findex REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS
8265 @findex #pragma
8266 @findex pragma
8267 @item REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS (@var{pfile})
8268 Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
8269 If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to the
8270 @code{cpp_register_pragma} and/or @code{cpp_register_pragma_space}
8271 functions. The @var{pfile} argument is the first argument to supply to
8272 these functions. The macro may also do setup required for the pragmas.
8273
8274 The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
8275 other compilers for the same target. In general, we discourage
8276 definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
8277
8278 If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then the macro
8279 @samp{INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} might be a useful one to define as well.
8280
8281 Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded. All
8282 @samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
8283 silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
8284
8285 @deftypefun void cpp_register_pragma (cpp_reader *@var{pfile}, const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (cpp_reader *))
8286
8287 Each call to @code{cpp_register_pragma} establishes one pragma. The
8288 @var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
8289 pragma of the form
8290
8291 @smallexample
8292 #pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
8293 @end smallexample
8294
8295 @var{space} must have been the subject of a previous call to
8296 @code{cpp_register_pragma_space}, or else be a null pointer. The
8297 callback routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, but must
8298 not use it for anything (this may change in the future). It may read
8299 any text after the @var{name} by making calls to @code{c_lex}. Text
8300 which is not read by the callback will be silently ignored.
8301
8302 Note that both @var{space} and @var{name} are case sensitive.
8303
8304 For an example use of this routine, see @file{c4x.h} and the callback
8305 routines defined in @file{c4x.c}.
8306
8307 Note that the use of @code{c_lex} is specific to the C and C++
8308 compilers. It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
8309 other language compilers for that matter. Thus if @code{c_lex} is going
8310 to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
8311 building the C and C++ compilers. This can be done by defining the
8312 variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
8313 target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file. These variables should name
8314 the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
8315 code that uses @code{c_lex}. Note it will also be necessary to add a
8316 rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
8317 how to build this object file.
8318 @end deftypefun
8319
8320 @deftypefun void cpp_register_pragma_space (cpp_reader *@var{pfile}, const char *@var{space})
8321 This routine establishes a namespace for pragmas, which will be
8322 registered by subsequent calls to @code{cpp_register_pragma}. For
8323 example, pragmas defined by the C standard are in the @samp{STDC}
8324 namespace, and pragmas specific to GCC are in the @samp{GCC} namespace.
8325
8326 For an example use of this routine in a target header, see @file{v850.h}.
8327 @end deftypefun
8328
8329 @findex HANDLE_SYSV_PRAGMA
8330 @findex #pragma
8331 @findex pragma
8332 @item HANDLE_SYSV_PRAGMA
8333 Define this macro (to a value of 1) if you want the System V style
8334 pragmas @samp{#pragma pack(<n>)} and @samp{#pragma weak <name>
8335 [=<value>]} to be supported by gcc.
8336
8337 The pack pragma specifies the maximum alignment (in bytes) of fields
8338 within a structure, in much the same way as the @samp{__aligned__} and
8339 @samp{__packed__} @code{__attribute__}s do. A pack value of zero resets
8340 the behaviour to the default.
8341
8342 The weak pragma only works if @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK} and
8343 @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} are defined. If enabled it allows the creation
8344 of specifically named weak labels, optionally with a value.
8345
8346 @findex HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_PUSH_POP
8347 @findex #pragma
8348 @findex pragma
8349 @item HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_PUSH_POP
8350 Define this macro (to a value of 1) if you want to support the Win32
8351 style pragmas @samp{#pragma pack(push,@var{n})} and @samp{#pragma
8352 pack(pop)}. The @samp{pack(push,@var{n})} pragma specifies the maximum alignment
8353 (in bytes) of fields within a structure, in much the same way as the
8354 @samp{__aligned__} and @samp{__packed__} @code{__attribute__}s do. A
8355 pack value of zero resets the behaviour to the default. Successive
8356 invocations of this pragma cause the previous values to be stacked, so
8357 that invocations of @samp{#pragma pack(pop)} will return to the previous
8358 value.
8359 @end table
8360
8361 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_VALID_DECL_ATTRIBUTE (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{attributes}, tree @var{identifier}, tree @var{args})
8362 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns nonzero if @var{identifier} with
8363 arguments @var{args} is a valid machine specific attribute for @var{decl}.
8364 The attributes in @var{attributes} have previously been assigned to @var{decl}.
8365 @end deftypefn
8366
8367 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_VALID_TYPE_ATTRIBUTE (tree @var{type}, tree @var{attributes}, tree @var{identifier}, tree @var{args})
8368 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns nonzero if @var{identifier} with
8369 arguments @var{args} is a valid machine specific attribute for @var{type}.
8370 The attributes in @var{attributes} have previously been assigned to @var{type}.
8371 @end deftypefn
8372
8373 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type1}, tree @var{type2})
8374 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
8375 @var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
8376 and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
8377 generated). If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
8378 supposed always to be compatible.
8379 @end deftypefn
8380
8381 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type})
8382 If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
8383 newly defined @var{type}.
8384 @end deftypefn
8385
8386 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type1}, tree @var{type2})
8387 Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
8388 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
8389 @code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}. It is assumed
8390 that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1. This
8391 function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
8392 merging.
8393 @end deftypefn
8394
8395 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{olddecl}, tree @var{newdecl})
8396 Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
8397 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
8398 @code{DECL_MACHINE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
8399 @var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}. Examples of
8400 when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
8401 attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition. This function may
8402 call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
8403
8404 @findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
8405 If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport} for
8406 Windows targets, you should define the macro
8407 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. This links in a function
8408 called @code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined
8409 as the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. This is done
8410 in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and @file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
8411 @end deftypefn
8412
8413 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{node}, tree *@var{attr_ptr})
8414 Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
8415 when it is being created. This is normally useful for back ends which
8416 wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
8417 the pragma's effect. The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
8418 created. The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
8419 for this decl. The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
8420 shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
8421 the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
8422 attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
8423 needed.
8424 @end deftypefn
8425
8426 @table @code
8427 @findex DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
8428 @item DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
8429 Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in identifier
8430 names. 0 means @samp{$} is not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed.
8431 1 is the default; there is no need to define this macro in that case.
8432 This macro controls the compiler proper; it does not affect the preprocessor.
8433
8434 @findex NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
8435 @item NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
8436 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
8437 @samp{$} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in
8438 G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers. If this macro is defined,
8439 @samp{.} is used instead.
8440
8441 @findex NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
8442 @item NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
8443 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
8444 @samp{.} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in G++
8445 have names that use @samp{.}. If this macro is defined, these names
8446 are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
8447
8448 @findex DEFAULT_MAIN_RETURN
8449 @item DEFAULT_MAIN_RETURN
8450 Define this macro if the target system expects every program's @code{main}
8451 function to return a standard ``success'' value by default (if no other
8452 value is explicitly returned).
8453
8454 The definition should be a C statement (sans semicolon) to generate the
8455 appropriate rtl instructions. It is used only when compiling the end of
8456 @code{main}.
8457
8458 @item NEED_ATEXIT
8459 @findex NEED_ATEXIT
8460 Define this if the target system lacks the function @code{atexit}
8461 from the ISO C standard. If this macro is defined, a default definition
8462 will be provided to support C++. If @code{ON_EXIT} is not defined,
8463 a default @code{exit} function will also be provided.
8464
8465 @item ON_EXIT
8466 @findex ON_EXIT
8467 Define this macro if the target has another way to implement atexit
8468 functionality without replacing @code{exit}. For instance, SunOS 4 has
8469 a similar @code{on_exit} library function.
8470
8471 The definition should be a functional macro which can be used just like
8472 the @code{atexit} function.
8473
8474 @item EXIT_BODY
8475 @findex EXIT_BODY
8476 Define this if your @code{exit} function needs to do something
8477 besides calling an external function @code{_cleanup} before
8478 terminating with @code{_exit}. The @code{EXIT_BODY} macro is
8479 only needed if @code{NEED_ATEXIT} is defined and @code{ON_EXIT} is not
8480 defined.
8481
8482 @findex INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED
8483 @item INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
8484 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
8485 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
8486 even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
8487 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
8488 every @code{call_insn} has this behavior. On machines where some @code{insn}
8489 or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
8490 you should define this macro.
8491
8492 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
8493
8494 @findex INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED
8495 @item INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
8496 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
8497 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
8498 even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
8499 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}. On machines where
8500 some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
8501 are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
8502 define this macro. Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
8503 instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
8504 slot of @var{insn}.
8505
8506 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
8507
8508 @findex MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG
8509 @item MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG (@var{insn})
8510 In rare cases, correct code generation requires extra machine
8511 dependent processing between the second jump optimization pass and
8512 delayed branch scheduling. On those machines, define this macro as a C
8513 statement to act on the code starting at @var{insn}.
8514
8515 @findex MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
8516 @item MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
8517 Define this macro if in some cases global symbols from one translation
8518 unit may not be bound to undefined symbols in another translation unit
8519 without user intervention. For instance, under Microsoft Windows
8520 symbols must be explicitly imported from shared libraries (DLLs).
8521
8522 @findex MD_ASM_CLOBBERS
8523 @item MD_ASM_CLOBBERS (@var{clobbers})
8524 A C statement that adds to @var{clobbers} @code{STRING_CST} trees for
8525 any hard regs the port wishes to automatically clobber for all asms.
8526
8527 @findex ISSUE_RATE
8528 @item ISSUE_RATE
8529 A C expression that returns how many instructions can be issued at the
8530 same time if the machine is a superscalar machine.
8531
8532 @findex MD_SCHED_INIT
8533 @item MD_SCHED_INIT (@var{file}, @var{verbose}, @var{max_ready})
8534 A C statement which is executed by the scheduler at the
8535 beginning of each block of instructions that are to be scheduled.
8536 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
8537 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
8538 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{max_ready} is the maximum number
8539 of insns in the current scheduling region that can be live at the same
8540 time. This can be used to allocate scratch space if it is needed.
8541
8542 @findex MD_SCHED_FINISH
8543 @item MD_SCHED_FINISH (@var{file}, @var{verbose})
8544 A C statement which is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block
8545 of instructions that are to be scheduled. It can be used to perform
8546 cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling macros.
8547 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
8548 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
8549 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
8550
8551 @findex MD_SCHED_REORDER
8552 @item MD_SCHED_REORDER (@var{file}, @var{verbose}, @var{ready}, @var{n_ready}, @var{clock}, @var{can_issue_more})
8553 A C statement which is executed by the scheduler after it
8554 has scheduled the ready list to allow the machine description to reorder
8555 it (for example to combine two small instructions together on
8556 @samp{VLIW} machines). @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio
8557 stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level
8558 provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{ready} is a pointer to
8559 the ready list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled.
8560 @var{n_ready} is the number of elements in the ready list. The
8561 scheduler reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
8562 @var{ready}[@var{n_ready}-1] and going to @var{ready}[0]. @var{clock}
8563 is the timer tick of the scheduler. @var{can_issue_more} is an output
8564 parameter that is set to the number of insns that can issue this clock;
8565 normally this is just @code{issue_rate}. See also @samp{MD_SCHED_REORDER2}.
8566
8567 @findex MD_SCHED_REORDER2
8568 @item MD_SCHED_REORDER2 (@var{file}, @var{verbose}, @var{ready}, @var{n_ready}, @var{clock}, @var{can_issue_more})
8569 Like @samp{MD_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time. While the
8570 @samp{MD_SCHED_REORDER} macro is called whenever the scheduler starts a
8571 new cycle, this macro is used immediately after @samp{MD_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}
8572 is called; it can reorder the ready list and set @var{can_issue_more} to
8573 determine whether there are more insns to be scheduled in the same cycle.
8574 Defining this macro can be useful if there are frequent situations where
8575 scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same cycle,
8576 these other insns can then be taken into account properly.
8577
8578 @findex MD_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE
8579 @item MD_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE (@var{file}, @var{verbose}, @var{insn}, @var{more})
8580 A C statement which is executed by the scheduler after it
8581 has scheduled an insn from the ready list. @var{file} is either a null
8582 pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose}
8583 is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
8584 @var{insn} is the instruction that was scheduled. @var{more} is the
8585 number of instructions that can be issued in the current cycle. The
8586 @samp{MD_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE} macro is responsible for updating the
8587 value of @var{more} (typically by @samp{@var{more}--}).
8588
8589 @findex MAX_INTEGER_COMPUTATION_MODE
8590 @item MAX_INTEGER_COMPUTATION_MODE
8591 Define this to the largest integer machine mode which can be used for
8592 operations other than load, store and copy operations.
8593
8594 You need only define this macro if the target holds values larger than
8595 @code{word_mode} in general purpose registers. Most targets should not define
8596 this macro.
8597
8598 @findex MATH_LIBRARY
8599 @item MATH_LIBRARY
8600 Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
8601 in the system math library, or @samp{""} if the target does not have a
8602 separate math library.
8603
8604 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"-lm"} is wrong.
8605
8606 @findex LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
8607 @item LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
8608 Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
8609 specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
8610
8611 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
8612 is wrong.
8613
8614 @findex TARGET_HAS_F_SETLKW
8615 @item TARGET_HAS_F_SETLKW
8616 Define this macro if the target supports file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
8617 Note that this functionality is part of POSIX@.
8618 Defining @code{TARGET_HAS_F_SETLKW} will enable the test coverage code
8619 to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
8620 if the program has forked.
8621
8622 @findex MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
8623 @item MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
8624
8625 A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
8626 conditional execution instructions instead of a branch. A value of
8627 @code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
8628 1 if it does use cc0.
8629
8630 @findex IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS
8631 @item IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS
8632 A C expression to modify the tests in @code{TRUE_EXPR}, and
8633 @code{FALSE_EXPR} for use in converting insns in @code{TEST_BB},
8634 @code{THEN_BB}, @code{ELSE_BB}, and @code{JOIN_BB} basic blocks to
8635 conditional execution. Set either @code{TRUE_EXPR} or @code{FALSE_EXPR}
8636 to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
8637
8638 @findex IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN
8639 @item IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN
8640 A C expression to modify the @code{PATTERN} of an @code{INSN} that is to
8641 be converted to conditional execution format.
8642
8643 @findex IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL
8644 @item IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL
8645 A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
8646 converting code to conditional execution in the basic blocks
8647 @code{TEST_BB}, @code{THEN_BB}, @code{ELSE_BB}, and @code{JOIN_BB}.
8648
8649 @findex IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL
8650 @item IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL
8651 A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
8652 converting code to conditional execution in the basic blocks
8653 @code{TEST_BB}, @code{THEN_BB}, @code{ELSE_BB}, and @code{JOIN_BB}.
8654
8655 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS ()
8656 Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
8657 that need to be defined. It should be a function that performs the
8658 necessary setup.
8659
8660 Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
8661 instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
8662 they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
8663 instructions or prefetch instructions).
8664
8665 To create a built-in function, call the function @code{builtin_function}
8666 which is defined by the language front end. You can use any type nodes set
8667 up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes} and @code{build_common_tree_nodes_2};
8668 only language front ends that use these two functions will use
8669 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
8670 @end deftypefn
8671
8672 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN (tree @var{exp}, rtx @var{target}, rtx @var{subtarget}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{ignore})
8673
8674 Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
8675 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{exp} is the expression for the
8676 function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
8677 convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
8678 @var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
8679 @var{exp}'s operands. @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
8680 ignored. This function should return the result of the call to the
8681 built-in function.
8682 @end deftypefn
8683
8684 @findex MD_CAN_REDIRECT_BRANCH
8685 @item MD_CAN_REDIRECT_BRANCH(@var{branch1}, @var{branch2})
8686
8687 Take a branch insn in @var{branch1} and a another in @var{branch2}.
8688 Return true if redirecting @var{branch1} to the destination of
8689 @var{branch2} is possible.
8690
8691 On some targets, branches may have a limited range. Optimizing the
8692 filling of delay slots can result in branches being redirected, and this
8693 may in turn cause a branch offset to overflow.
8694
8695 @end table
This page took 0.437654 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.